Mindray Accutorr Plus 2.5 Service manual

Add to my manuals
236 Pages

advertisement

Mindray Accutorr Plus 2.5 Service manual | Manualzz
VAULT COPY
INTRODUCTION
Chapters
1. Operation
2. Theory of Operation
3. Specifications
Rev AB.1 is available in Vault-PM on Voyager
4. Repair Information
5. Schematics
6. Parts
7. Calibration
8. Preventive Maintenance
A complete, detailed table of contents begins on page iii. Also, on the first page of each
chapter a table of contents for that chapter is provided.
FOREWORD
This Service Manual (P/N 0070-00-0429) is intended as a guide, for technically qualified
personnel, to use during repair and calibration procedures for the Accutorr Plus (part
number 0998-00-0444-XX). NOTE: See the serial number label on the rear panel of the
unit for part number identification. This manual also includes information on the Recorder
and Predictive Temperature Modules.
The information in this manual has been divided into the eight chapters listed above.
This publication may have been updated to reflect product design changes and/or manual
improvements. Any such changes to this manual would be accomplished by supplying
replacement pages and instructions for inserting or affixing them into the manual.
NOTE
Unauthorized servicing may void the remainder of the warranty. Check with the
factory or with a local authorized Datascope representative to determine the
warranty status of a particular instrument.
NOTE: This product is year 2000 compliant.
Copyright © Datascope Corp., 1999. Printed in U.S.A. All rights reserved. Contents of this
publication may not be reproduced in any form without permission of Datascope Corp.
Accutorr Plus, Service Manual
Chapter 1 - Operation
i
This page intentionally left blank.
ii
Accutorr Plus, Service Manual
Chapter 1 - Operation
TABLE OF CONTENTS
INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . i
1.0 OPERATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1
1.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1
1.2 Controls and Indicators. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3
1.2.1
Front Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4
1.2.2
Rear Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13
1.2.3
Predictive Thermometer Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14
1.2.4
Recorder Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15
1.3 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-17
1.3.1
Setting-Up / Turning Power On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-17
1.3.2
Patient Setup and Room/Bed Assignment. . . . . . . . . . . 1-18
1.3.2.1 Selecting the Patient Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18
1.3.2.2 Cuff Inflation Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18
1.3.2.3 Room Number and Bed Letter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-19
1.3.3
Manual NIBP Measurements and General NIBP
Measurement Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-20
1.3.3.1 NIBP Pressure Limit Fail Safe. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-22
1.3.3.2 Cuff Inflation Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-22
1.3.3.3 Automatic Adjustment of Cuff Inflation Pressure
(Adaptive Inflation) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-22
1.3.4
Automatic NIBP Measurements (Interval Mode) . . . . . 1-23
1.3.4.1 Canceling an Automatic NIBP Measurement . . . . . . . . 1-23
1.3.4.2 Changing the Interval setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-24
1.3.4.3 Effects of Changing the Room Number and /or Bed
Letter on the Interval Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-24
1.3.4.4 Start and Deflate Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-24
1.3.5
Alarms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-25
1.3.5.1 Setting Alarm Limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-25
1.3.5.2 Alarm Violations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-26
1.3.5.3 How to Mute Alarms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-27
1.3.5.4 Alarms and Changing the Room Number and/or
Bed Letter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-27
1.3.6
To View and Delete Stored Data (Trend Mode). . . . . . . 1-28
1.3.6.1 To View the Stored Measurements on the Accutorr
Plus NIBP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-28
1.3.6.2 To View the Stored Measurements on the Accutorr
Plus NIBP with Trend Screen and the Accutorr Plus
NIBP with Trend Screen and SpO2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-29
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Introduction
iii
1.3.6.3
1.3.7
1.3.8
1.3.9
1.3.10
1.3.10.1
1.3.10.2
1.3.10.3
1.3.11
1.3.11.1
1.3.11.2
1.3.11.3
1.3.11.4
1.3.12
1.3.13
1.3.14
1.3.15
1.3.16
1.3.17
1.3.18
1.3.19
To Delete the Stored Measurements on all
Models of the Accutorr Plus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-29
Setting the Alarm Volume and Beep Volume . . . . . . . . 1-30
Setting the LCD Contrast (View Angle Adjustment) . . 1-31
Display Time Out Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-32
SpO2 Measurements (Accutorr Plus model with SpO2) . 1-33
Datascope Pulse Oximetry Sensors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-33
Sequence for Establishing SpO2 with Nellcor® Pulse
Oximetry* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-37
Sequence for Establishing SpO2 with MasimoÒ Pulse
Oximetry* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-40
Temperature Measurement (optional) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-43
Predictive Thermometer Measurements . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-43
How to Apply Probe Cover (PTM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-43
How to Take Oral, Rectal, and Axillary Temperatures . 1-44
Storing Temperature Measurements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-45
Recorder (optional) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-46
How to Set the Clock (Date and Time) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-47
Battery Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-48
User Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-49
Status and Error Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-51
How to Attach Optional Thermometer and
Recorder Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-52
Placement of the Quick Reference Card . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-53
Placement of Recorder Paper Loading Label . . . . . . . . . 1-54
2.0 THEORY OF OPERATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1
2.1 Block Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1
2.2 Detailed Circuit Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2
2.2.1
LED/CPU Module, 0670-00-0650-03, -04 . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
2.2.1.1 Hardware Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
2.2.1.2 Software Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
2.2.1.3 Detailed Hardware Description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10
2.2.2
NIBP Module, Linear Bleed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-17
2.2.3
Recorder Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-20
2.2.4
Predictive Thermometer Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-21
2.2.5
SpO2 Module (Accutorr Plus with SpO2 only) . . . . . . . 2-22
2.2.6
Main Power Supply. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-25
2.2.7
Communication Board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-26
2.2.8
LCD Inverter Module - 0670-00-0649 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-28
2.2.9
Nellcor® MP 304 SpO2 Circuit Board
Theory of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-29
2.2.10 Interface NellcorÒ Board Theory of Operation . . . . . . . 2-30
iv
Revised 12/20/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Introduction
2.2.11
2.2.12
Masimo SETÒ Technology. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-31
Masimo Interface Board Theory of Operation . . . . . . . . 2-32
3.0 SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1
3.1.
3.2
3.3
3.4
3.5
3.6
3.7
Performance Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1
Safety Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6
Physical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7
Environmental Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7
Electrical Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7
Agency Compliance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8
Electromagnetic Compatibility. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8
4.0 REPAIR INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1
4.1
4.2
4.3
4.4
4.5
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1
Safety Precautions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2
General Troubleshooting Guidelines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2
Test Equipment Required . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3
Troubleshooting (Problem Isolation) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4
4.5.1
Isolating the Problem, System Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5
4.5.2
Isolating the Problem within the Main Unit . . . . . . . . . 4-5
4.5.3
Isolating the Problem with Optional Accessory Modules. . . 4-6
4.5.4
Clinical Issues . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6
4.6 Disassembly Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9
4.6.1
Removal of the Rear Housing (27) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9
4.6.2
Removal of the Front Bezel (2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9
4.6.3
Removal of the Keyboard Assembly (4). . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9
4.6.4
Removal of the CPU Board Assembly (8) . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10
4.6.5
Removal of the NIBP Circuit Assembly (30) . . . . . . . . 4-10
4.6.6
Removal of the Power Supply Assembly (41) . . . . . . . . 4-10
4.6.7
Removal of the Motor Filter and LCD
High Voltage Assembly (35) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11
4.6.8
Removal of the NIBP Air Pump Assembly (37) . . . . . . 4-11
4.6.9
Removal of the LCD Display Assembly and Back Light (5) 4-11
4.6.10 Removal of the SpO2 Circuit Board (40) . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11
4.6.11 Removal and Replacement of the Internal Sealed
Lead Acid or Li-Ion Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12
4.6.12 Removal of the AC Input Receptacle Assembly (16) . . . 4-12
4.6.13 Thermal Printer (Optional Module) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12
4.6.14 Thermometer, Predictive (Optional Module) . . . . . . . . 4-13
4.6.15 AccuTemp IR, Infrared Thermometer (optional
module) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13
4.6.16 AccuTemp IR Mounting Cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Introduction
Revised 12/20/00
v
4.6.17
Communication Board (45). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13
5.0 ASSEMBLY AND SCHEMATIC DIAGRAMS . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-1
6.0 REPLACEMENT PARTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1
6.1
6.2
6.3
6.4
6.5
6.6
6.7
6.8
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1
Available Replacement Parts and Sub-Assemblies . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1
Product Variations and Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1
Exchange Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1
Replacement Parts Pricing Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2
Ordering Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2
Abbreviations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3
Isometric Drawings and Parts List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5
6.8.1
Accutorr Plus Isometric Parts List (All Models) . . . . . . 6-5
6.8.2
Recorder Module Isometric Parts List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13
6.8.3
Predictive Temperature Module Isometric Parts List. . . 6-15
6.8.4
Mobile Stand Type 1 (Gray Base) Assembly Parts List . 6-17
6.8.5
Mobile Stand Type 2 (Black Base) Assembly Parts List . 6-19
6.8.6
Mounting Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-19
6.9 Circuit Board Parts Lists. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-21
7.0 CALIBRATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-1
7.1
7.2
7.3
7.4
7.5
vi
Revised 9/20/07
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3
Warnings and Guidelines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3
Test Equipment and Special Tools Required. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3
Power-Up Sequence, Internal Testing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
Service Diagnostics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
7.5.1
Introduction (Hidden Key) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
7.5.2
Software Version Test (0a, 0b). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-5
7.5.3
Keypad Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6
7.5.4
LED Test (2a, 2b) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-7
7.5.5
Communications Test (3a, 3b) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-7
7.5.6
Recorder Test (4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-7
7.5.6.1 Recorder Print Head Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8
7.5.7
Pump Test (5). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8
7.5.8
Leak Test (7) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9
7.5.9
Over Pressure Test (8a, 8b, 8c) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9
7.5.10 Pulse Channel DC Offset Test (9a, 9b, 9c) . . . . . . . . . . 7-10
7.5.11 Pulse Channel Average Noise Test (10a, 10b, 10c) . . . . 7-10
7.5.12
Main Pressure Transducer Verification Test
(11a, 11b, 11c) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Introduction
7.5.13
7.6
7.7
7.8
7.9
7.10
Verification of Accutorr Plus Pneumatic Performance,
Using the “Cufflink” NIBP Emulator (11d) . . . . . . . . . 7-11
7.5.14 Over Pressure Transducer Verification (12c, 12a, 12b) . 7-12
7.5.15 Main Pressure Transducer Calibration. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-12
7.5.16 Over Pressure Transducer Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-13
7.5.17 Battery Selection (13) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-13
Predictive Thermometer Verification and Calibration. . . . . . . . . . 7-14
7.6.1
Temperature Accuracy Verification with the
Predictive Temperature Simulator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-14
7.6.2
Water Bath Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-15
7.6.3
System Calibration Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-15
7.6.4
Temperature Verification Test, Infrared
Thermometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-16
7.6.5
Low Battery Sensing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-17
Battery Test for Accutorr Plus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-18
7.7.1
Low Battery Indicator and Low Battery Cut-Off . . . . . . 7-18
7.7.2
Set the Current Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-19
NIBP Normal Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-20
Trend Memory Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-21
SpO2 Normal Operation (Accutorr Plus with SpO2 only) . . . . . . . 7-21
8.0 PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1
8.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1
8.2 Limitations of Physiological Simulators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1
8.3 Preventive Maintenance Schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2
8.3.1
Mechanical and Physical Visual Inspection
(One Year Interval) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2
8.3.2
Electrical Safety and Performance Checks
(One Year Interval) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Introduction
Revised 09/20/07
vii
This page intentionally left blank.
viii
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Introduction
1.0 OPERATION
CONTENTS OF THIS CHAPTER
Page
1.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1
1.2 Controls and Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3
1.3 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-17
1.1 INTRODUCTION
This section of the Service Manual (P/N 0070-00-0429) is provided as a review
of the Accutorr Plus NIBP, the Accutorr Plus NIBP with Trend Screen and the Accutorr
Plus NIBP with Trend Screen and SpO2 functions and operation. The reader is
encouraged to refer to the Operating Instructions, P/N 0070-00-0428, for more
complete details.
Accutorr Plus, Service Manual
Chapter 1 - Operation
Revised 06/25/99
1-1
This page intentionally left blank.
1-2
Accutorr Plus, Service Manual
Chapter 1 - Operation
1.2 CONTROLS AND INDICATORS
This section of the Service Manual identifies and describes each control and display of the
Datascope Accutorr Plus NIBP, the Accutorr Plus NIBP with Trend Screen and the
Accutorr Plus NIBP with Trend Screen and SpO2. For step-by-step operating instructions
see Chapter 1.3, “Operation”.
The following is a list of all controls, connectors and indicators, their item number and
the page number. The item number refers to the call outs on the drawings within this
chapter. The page number refers to the page where the description of the item can be
found.
CONTROL
Page #
CONTROL
Page#
30. Mute Key
31. Mute Indicator
1-10
1-11
32. Timer/Temp Key
1-11
FRONT PANEL
1.
NIBP Systolic Display
1-8
2.
3.
NIBP Diastolic Display
NIBP MAP Display
1-8
1-8
4.
Pulse Rate Display
NIBP/SpO2 Pulse Rate Indicator
SpO2 Display
Liquid Crystal Display (LCD)
1-8
1-8
1-8
1-8
5.
6.
7.
33. Interval/Elap. Time/Temp Display 1-11
34. Interval Key
1-11
35. Interval Indicator
36. Deflate Key
37. Patient Setup Key
1-11
1-12
1-12
8. Menu Key
9. LCD Up Arrow Key
10. LCD Down Arrow Key
1-8
1-8
1-8
38. Start NIBP Key
39. Start NIBP Indicator
40. Patient Size Indicators
1-12
1-12
1-12
11. Select Key
12. Print Key
13. Print Indicator
1-9
1-9
1-9
41. Hidden Key
1-12
14. Defaults Key
15. Datascope, Nellcor ® or Masimo
SpO2 Connector
16. AC Power Indicator
1-9
REAR PANEL
42. Thermometer Module Connector
1-13
43. Equipotential Lug
44. AC Power Connector
45. Communications Connector
1-13
1-13
1-13
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
27.
28.
29.
1-9
1-9
1-9
1-9
1-10
1-10
1-10
1-10
1-10
1-10
1-10
1-10
1-11
46. Datascope Connector
47. Pole Mounting Handle and Cam
48. Recorder Module Connector
1-13
1-13
1-13
Battery Indicator
NIBP Connector
On/Standby Key
Memory Full Indicator
Delete Info. Key
Data Scan Key
Data Scan Indicator
Room/Bed Key
Bed Letter Display
Room Number Display
Patient Info. Down Arrow Key
Patient Info. Up Arrow Key
Set Alarms Key
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
1-9
1-9
PREDICTIVE THERMOMETER MODULE
49. Probe Cover Holder
1-14
50. Probe Chamber
1-14
51. Probe Connector
1-14
RECORDER MODULE
52. Paper Door
1-15
53. Paper Tear Edge
1-15
Revised 02/15/00
1-3
1.2.1
Front Panel
40
41
1
NIBP
39
SYS.
2
3
PATIENT
SETUP
START
NIBP
38
DEFLATE
36
INTERVAL
34
35
DIA.
TIMER/TEMP
4
33
32
MAP
5
INTERVAL ELAP. TIME TEMP
30
ALARMS
NIBP
SET
ALARMS
MUTE
6
28
26
Sp02
ROOM
BED
PATIENT INFO.
SpO2
ROOM
BED
29
27
25
24
DELETE
INFO.
MEMORY FULL
8
31
DATA
SCAN
7
20/05
20/05
20/05
20/05
20/05
37
03:00
02:58
02:35
02:33
02:30
S / D / M
114/64 83
123/61 84
127/62 83
185/105 135
129/62 84
61
60
58
56
59
+ -
MENU
SELECT
HOLD TO CLEAR.
22
F/C %SPO2
98.7
96
98.5
97
96
97.6
96
---98.2
97
o
DEFAULTS
PRINT
23
21
20
ON
STANDBY
19
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
Figure 1-1 Front Panel - Accutorr Plus NIBP with Trend Screen and Datascope SpO2
1-4
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
40
41
1
NIBP
39
SYS.
2
3
PATIENT
SETUP
START
NIBP
38
DEFLATE
36
INTERVAL
34
35
DIA.
TIMER/TEMP
4
33
32
MAP
5
INTERVAL ELAP. TIME TEMP
30
ALARMS
NIBP
SET
ALARMS
MUTE
6
28
26
Sp02
ROOM
BED
PATIENT INFO.
SpO2
31
29
27
25
24
DATA
SCAN
ROOM
7
BED
DELETE
INFO.
MEMORY FULL
03:00
02:58
02:35
02:33
02:30
20/05
20/05
20/05
20/05
20/05
8
37
S / D / M
114/64 83
123/61 84
127/62 83
185/105 135
129/62 84
61
60
58
56
59
+ -
MENU
SELECT
HOLD TO CLEAR.
22
F/C %SPO2
98.7
96
98.5
97
96
97.6
96
---98.2
97
o
DEFAULTS
PRINT
23
21
20
ON
STANDBY
Nellcor
19
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
Figure 1-2 Front Panel - Accutorr Plus NIBP with Trend Screen and Nellcor® or Masimo SpO2
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
Revised 02/15/00
1-5
1. NIBP Systolic Display
Displays the systolic blood pressure data from NIBP measurements. It is also used to
display NIBP error codes and systolic alarm limits.
2. NIBP Diastolic Display
Displays the diastolic blood pressure data from NIBP measurements. It is also used
to display diastolic alarm limits.
3. NIBP MAP Display
Displays the mean arterial pressure (MAP) information from NIBP measurements.
During a measurement, it will display the cuff pressure. It is also used to display the
MAP alarm limits and the inflation pressure when selecting the initial inflation
pressure.
4. Pulse Rate Display
Displays the pulse rate information from either the NIBP measurement or the SpO2
reading (Accutorr Plus model with SpO2). It is also used to display pulse rate alarm
limits.
5. NIBP/SpO2 Pulse Rate Indicator
When the pulse rate displayed is based on an NIBP measurement, then NIBP is illuminated. When the pulse rate displayed is based on an SpO2 measurement
(Accutorr Plus model with SpO2), then SpO2 is illuminated.
6. SpO2 Display (Accutorr Plus model with SpO2)
Displays the %SpO2 measurement information. This area is also used to display
the %SpO2 alarm limits.
7. Liquid Crystal Display (LCD) (Accutorr Plus models with Trend Screen)
The Liquid Crystal Display (LCD) is used to display previous measurements (trend
list) for the selected patient, or a menu that controls the beep volume and alarm volume.
8. Menu Key (Accutorr Plus models with Trend Screen)
This key is used to toggle between the trend list screen and the menu screen in the
LCD. When the back light in the LCD is off, pressing this key turns it on. This key
is also used to adjust the LCD contrast. Press and hold the key for two beeps to enter
the adjustment mode. Use the Arrow keys (9 and 10) to change the contrast.
9. LCD Up Arrow Key (Accutorr Plus models with Trend Screen)
This key is used to scroll the trend data so that more recent measurements are
displayed in the LCD. When the back light in the LCD is off, pressing this key turns
it on. This key is also used to adjust the LCD contrast when in the adjustment mode.
Use the Menu key (8) to enter the adjustment mode.
10. LCD Down Arrow Key (Accutorr Plus models with Trend Screen)
This key is used to scroll the trend data so that older measurements are displayed in
the LCD. When the back light in the LCD is off, pressing this key turns it on. This
key is also used to adjust the LCD contrast when in the adjustment mode. Use the
Menu key (8) to enter the adjustment mode.
1-8
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
11. Select Key (Accutorr Plus models with Trend Screen)
When the menu screen is displayed in the LCD, this key is used to select the menu
items. When the back light in the LCD is off, pressing this key turns it on.
12. Print Key
Press this key to print all stored information for the selected patient. Press to stop a
printing that is in process. Press and hold this key (2 single beep tones, approx. 3
seconds) to change the print mode between Continuous and Request. When in the
Continuous mode, the PRINT Indicator LED is illuminated. When loading in a new
roll of recorder paper, press this key to feed the paper through the printer.
13. Print Indicator
This indicator is illuminated when continuous printing of measurements is selected.
14. Defaults Key
Press and hold this key (2 single beep tones, approx. 3 seconds) to reset all parameters
back to the hospital default settings. This includes alarms, inflation pressure, interval,
etc... When in the process of making a change to a setting, you can return to the
original setting by momentarily pressing this key. To enter the User Configuration,
press and hold this key (1 beep tone), while turning the unit on. See section 1.3.15
for details on default settings and User Configuration.
15. SpO2 Connector (Accutorr Plus model with Datascope, Nellcor® or Masimo SpO2)
This connector is used to attach Datascope, Nellcor® or Masimo SpO2 sensors.
16. AC Power Indicator
This green LED illuminates whenever AC power is applied to the unit.
17. Battery Indicator
This green LED illuminates whenever the unit is operating on battery power. The
LED will flash when the battery requires charging. When the LED begins flashing,
approximately 30 minutes of battery time remain on the Accutorr Plus NIBP (20
minutes on the Accutorr Plus NIBP with Trend Screen and 10 minutes on the
Accutorr Plus NIBP with Trend Screen and SpO2).
18. NIBP Connector
This connector is used to attach specified NIBP hoses.
19. On/Standby Key
This key is used to activate the unit, enabling it to begin taking measurements. The
unit does not have to be “ON” for the internal battery to charge. However, the unit
does need to be plugged into an AC receptacle for the battery to be charging.
20. Memory Full Indicator
This LED indicator flashes when 80 - 99 of the 100 available entries of trend are
used. This LED is on continuously when 100 are used. Delete measurements
manually using the DELETE INFO. key or the unit will automatically delete the
oldest measurement for the current patient. NOTE: The unit will also automatically
delete data that is 24 hours old.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
Revised 02/15/00
1-9
21. Delete Info. Key
Press the Data Scan key to enable the Delete Info. key (Accutorr Plus without Trend
and SpO2 only). Once enabled, press and hold this key (1 beep tone, approx. 3 seconds)
to delete the most recent reading when it is displayed. When displaying any
measurement, press and hold this key (2 beep tones, approx. 6 seconds) to delete all
information for the currently selected patient. Press and hold at power up to delete
all information for all patients.
22. Data Scan Key
Press this key (1 beep tone) to view previous measurements for the selected patient
on the Accutorr Plus NIBP and to enable the Delete Info. key (Accutorr Plus without Trend and SpO2 only). The LED indicator next to the key illuminates. On the
Accutorr Plus NIBP, use the Patient Info. Up & Down Arrow keys (27 & 28) to
scroll through the stored measurements for the selected patient. On all models of the
Accutorr Plus, press and hold this key (2 beep tones, approx. 6 seconds) to scan all of
the rooms and beds for stored measurements. Press the Data Scan key again to stop
on a particular room/bed. Press the Data Scan key again to exit this view mode.
23. Data Scan Indicator
This LED indicator is illuminated when viewing prior data.
24. Room/Bed Number Key
Press this key to change the displayed Room/Bed. After pressing this key use the
Patient Info. Up & Down Arrow keys (27 & 28) to change the Room/Bed. This key
is also used when selecting a User Configuration item.
25. Bed Letter Display
This display is used to show the current patient bed letter. It is also used to display
status codes for NIBP, SpO2 and Temperature and to display User Configuration
items.
26. Room Number Display
This display is used to show the current patient room number. It is also used to
display status codes for NIBP, SpO2 and Temperature, indicates which alarm is
being set (Hi or Lo), and displays a User Configuration item.
27. Patient Info. Down Arrow Key
This key is used to decrement the alarm limits when they are shown on the LED
displays and to decrement the hours, minutes, month, day and year in the clock set
mode. This key is also used to change the Room/Bed, to scroll through previous data
and to change initial inflation pressure.
28. Patient Info. Up Arrow Key
This key is used to increment the alarm limits when they are shown on the LED
displays and to increment the hours, minutes, month, day and year in the clock set
mode. This key is also used to change the Room/Bed, to scroll through previous data
and to change initial inflation pressure.
1-10
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
29. Set Alarms Key
This key is used to select the NIBP and SpO2 (Accutorr Plus model with SpO2)
alarms to be changed. Repeated presses of this key sequences through the choices of
Systolic Hi, Systolic Lo, Diastolic Hi, Diastolic Lo, Map Hi, Map Lo, Pulse Rate Hi,
Pulse Rate Lo, SpO2 Hi and SpO2 Lo. After the last available parameter, the next
press returns the unit to normal operation. Once the desired parameter is flashing,
use the Patient Info. Up & Down Arrow keys (27 & 28) to increment or decrement
the alarm values.
30. Mute Key
Press this key (one beep tone), to silence the current alarm tone for 2 minutes. If a
new alarm is detected during the 2 minutes, a new alarm tone will sound. Press and
hold (2 beep tones, approx. 3 seconds) to permanently silence all alarm tones. Press
this key again (1 beep tone), to activate alarm tones.
31. Mute Indicator
This LED indicator is illuminated when the alarm tone has been silenced permanently
and when the alarm volume is set to OFF.
32. Timer/Temp Key
This key is used to switch between viewing the elapsed time or the temperature in
the Interval/Elap. Time/Temp Display. When viewing stored measurements on the
Accutorr Plus NIBP, press this key to switch between viewing the temperature and
time of the measurement.
33. Interval/Elap. Time/Temp Display
This displays the time, in minutes since the last successful NIBP measurement (Elap.
Time is illuminated). When the Interval key is pressed, the Elap. Time changes to
the current Interval setting (Interval is illuminated). When the Predictive thermometer
probe is removed from its holder, the Elap. Time changes to Temp (Temp is illuminated).
Either “85.0" (° F) or ”29.4" (° C) will display; this is an internal self test feature. As
the Predictive thermometer is taking a measurement, the display will flash as the
number increases. When the final temperature measurement is determined, the display
will no longer flash and a beep tone is generated. When the AccuTemp IR thermometer
is used, the temperature is not displayed until after the measurement is taken and the
thermometer is placed back into its holder. This display will also show the current
time and date when setting the clock.
34. Interval Key
Press to enter the set time interval mode. An interval is set for automatic NIBP
measurement cycles. To sequence through the interval choices of: OFF (——, when
set to display graphics), CONT (Continuous), 1, 2.5, 5, 10, 15, 20, 30, 60, 120 and
240 minutes, repeatedly press the Interval key. When the desired interval is displayed
in the Interval/Elap. Time/Temp Display the TIMER/TEMP key may be pressed to
enter the interval setting or, the displayed setting will be entered when 15 seconds
have elapsed without pressing the Patient Info. Up or Down arrow keys (27 & 28).
35. Interval Indicator
When an interval setting is selected, except for Off, the Interval Indicator flashes.
When the interval mode is activated the Interval Indicator illuminates continuously.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
Revised 06/25/99
1-11
36. Deflate Key
Press this key to stop an NIBP measurement that is in progress and deflate the cuff. A
new measurement cycle will not be allowed for 10 seconds following the use of this
key. The Start NIBP LED indicator is illuminated when a new measurement can
begin. Press this key while in the interval mode to suspend the interval operation.
37. Patient Setup Key
Press this key (1 beep tone) to select the patient size. Each time the key is pressed the
patient size will change. The choices will cycle from Adult, Pediatric, Neonate,
Adult, Pediatric, Neonate, etc...
PRECAUTION: It is the users responsibility, when changing the room/bed, to assure the
patient size and alarm settings are set as required.
This key is also used to view the cuff inflation pressure for an NIBP measurement.
Press and hold (2 beep tones, approx. 3 seconds) to display the current inflation
pressure in the MAP display. Use the Patient Info. Up & Down Arrow keys (27 &
28) to change the cuff pressure.
38. Start NIBP Key
Press this key to initiate an NIBP measurement. If a measurement is already in
progress, a new measurement can not be initiated until a minimum of 10 seconds
after the end of the one in progress (30 seconds when in the interval mode). The Start
NIBP LED indicator is illuminated when a measurement can begin.
39. Start NIBP Indicator
This LED indicator is illuminated when the Accutorr Plus is ready to initiate an
NIBP measurement.
40. Patient Size Indicators
One of theses LEDs illuminates to indicate the selected patient size.
41. Hidden Key
To enter the Service Diagnostics mode, press and hold this key (1 beep tone) while
the Accutorr Plus is powering on and running the self tests (all “8"’s displayed in the
LEDs). The Service Diagnostics mode is used to initiate various performance tests
that are to be done by technical service personnel only. To exit Service Diagnostics,
power down the Accutorr Plus by pressing the On/Standby key.
1-12
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
1.2.2
Rear Panel
42
48
43
44
45
46
47
Figure 1-5 Rear Panel - All Units
42. Thermometer Module Connector
Used to attached one of the optional Datascope thermometer modules (PTM or
AccuTemp IR).
43. Equipotential Lug
Provides equipotential bonding between hospital equipment.
44. AC Power Connector
Allows for A.C. power cord connection.
45. Communications Connector
Provides compatible communications to external devices and hospital’s information
system.
46. Datascope Connector
Used by Datascope Technical Service Personnel.
47. Pole Mounting Handle and Cam
Provides the ability to quickly mount the Accutorr Plus to a rolling pole.
48. Recorder Module Connector
Used to connect the optional Datascope recorder module.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
1-13
1.2.3
Predictive Thermometer Module (PTM)
49
50
51
Figure 1-6 Predictive Thermometer Module
49. Probe Cover Holder
Used to store a box of probe covers.
50. Probe Chamber
Used to store the temperature probe when not in use.
51. Probe Connector
Used to connect the thermometer probe to the PTM module.
1-14
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
1.2.4
Recorder Module
52
53
Figure 1-7 Recorder Module
52. Paper Door
Open this door when loading recorder paper.
53. Paper Tear Edge
The paper tear edge is used to tear off printed recorder strips. The edge can be
removed in the event of a paper jam that needs to be cleared.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
1-15
This page intentionally left blank.
1-16
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
1.3. OPERATION
This section of the Service Manual provides guidelines and step-by-step instructions for proper
operation of the Accutorr Plus NIBP, Accutorr Plus NIBP with Trend Screen, and the Accutorr
Plus NIBP with Trend Screen and SpO2. The numbers in parentheses ( ) refer to the items described
in Section 1.2, “Controls and Indicators”. When a described feature refers to a particular
model, it will be noted. When the name Accutorr Plus is used, it refers to all 5 models.
1.3.1
SETTING-UP / TURNING POWER ON
1. Before turning the power on, check the rear panel for voltage requirements. Confirm
proper voltage is available.
2. Before turning the power on, connect any required modules (recorder,
thermometer). For instructions on connecting modules, see section 1.3.17.
Upon installation of any optional modules, a test is required after power up (step 5).
For the recorder, press the print key and the recorder will feed the paper to verify
proper function. For the Predictive thermometer, remove the probe from its holder
and verify 85.0 (29.4) appears in the Interval/Elap. Time/Temp display.
3. If additional communications capabilities are required, attach a communications
interface cable to the rear panel COMMUNICATIONS CONNECTOR (45) and to
the corresponding interface connector on the peripheral instrument.
4. Attach the AC power cord into the rear panel AC POWER CONNECTOR (44) and into a
grounded (3-prong) Hospital Grade AC receptacle. Do not use an adapter to defeat
the ground. The green AC POWER INDICATOR (16) illuminates, indicating AC power
has been applied. The internal battery charges automatically when AC power is applied.
WARNING: When attached to other products ensure that the total chassis leakage currents of
all units (combined) do not exceed 100mA.
5. Press the ON/STANDBY key (19) to activate the unit. If it is required to enter the
User Configuration mode, press and hold the DEFAULTS key (14) while the unit is
powering on. See section 1.3.15 for more details on the User Configuration mode.
6. The unit begins a countdown from 20 and performs internal diagnostic tests. Any
status codes are displayed in the appropriate LED. See section 1.3.16 for a list of
status codes. At the end of power up, all of the displays (including the LCD on the
Accutorr Plus models with Trend Screen) illuminate and then blank, except the Bed
Letter and Room Number displays (25 & 26) which does not blank. A beep tone will
sound during the power up sequence to confirm the operation of the audio indicator. If
the time and date need to be set, see section 1.3.13 for instructions.
7. On an Accutorr Plus models with Trend Screen, adjust the contrast on the LCD if
necessary. To adjust the contrast, press and hold the MENU key (8) (2 beep tones,
approx. 3 seconds). Use the LCD UP & LCD Down ARROW keys (9 & 10) to adjust
the contrast. See section 1.3.8, Setting the LCD Contrast, for more details.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
Revised 12/20/00
1-17
1.3.2
1.3.2.1
PATIENT SETUP AND ROOM/BED ASSIGNMENT
Selecting the Patient Size
The Patient Size is selected using the PATIENT SETUP key (37).
1. Press the PATIENT SETUP key (37) to
select the Patient size. Three choices are
available: Adult, Pediatric and Neonate.
Each time the key is pressed the patient
size changes. The indicator under the
graphic of the patient size illuminates to
indicate which size is selected. The
factory default setting for the Patient
size is Adult. See section 1.3.15, “User
Configuration” to set a custom default
setting. NOTE: Do not press and hold
the PATIENT SETUP key to change the
patient size. Pressing and holding this
key, enter the initial cuff inflation
pressure change mode.
1.3.2.2
Adult
Pediatric Neonate
PATIENT
SETUP
Figure 1-8 - Patient Size Graphics and Indicators
Cuff Inflation Pressure
The initial cuff inflation pressure depends on the Patient Size setting. The initial cuff
inflation pressures are listed in the table below. The initial cuff inflation pressures can
be modified from the default (custom or factory) settings. When the Accutorr Plus is
powered down, these modifications are deleted.
1. To change the initial cuff inflation pressure, press and hold the PATIENT SETUP key
(37) (2 beep tones, approx. 3 seconds). The current initial cuff pressure for the
selected patient size displays in the MAP display.
2. Use the Patient Info. Up and Down Arrow keys (27 & 28) to change the pressure.
3. Once the desired pressure is displayed, press the PATIENT SETUP key (37) to enter
this value. NOTE: Waiting 15 seconds will also enter this value.
PATIENT SIZE
SETTING
INITIAL FACTORY
DEFAULT CUFF
INFLATION VALUES
LOWEST
SELECTABLE
PRESSURE
HIGHEST
SELECTABLE
PRESSURE
INCREMENT
Adult
180 mmHg
100 mmHg
260 mmHg
5 mmHg
Pediatric
140 mmHg
60 mmHg
160 mmHg
5 mmHg
Neonate
100 mmHg
40 mmHg
120 mmHg
5 mmHg
NOTE: The default patient size and initial cuff inflation pressure can be customized. See
section 1.3.15, “User Configuration” for details on how to set custom defaults.
1-18
Revised 06/25/99
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
1.3.2.3 Room Number and Bed Letter
To monitor more than one patient, assign each patient to a particular room number and
bed letter. Use the ROOM/BED key (24) to set the room number from 0 to 99 and the
bed letter as a, b, c or d. On initial power up (no stored patient data), the room number
and bed letter default to 0,a.
1. Press the ROOM/BED key (24). The
ROOM LED flashes indicating that the
room number can now be changed.
2. Press the Patient Info. Up or Down Arrow
key (27 & 28) to increment or decrement
the room number.
Press to increase or
decrease the Room
Number and Bed Letter
ROOM
BED
PATIENT INFO.
DATA
SCAN
ROOM
BED
MEMORY FULL
3. Press the ROOM/BED key again. The
BED LED flashes.
DELETE
INFO.
Press to change
the Room Number
and Bed Letter
HOLD TO CLEAR.
Figure 1-9 - Room Number and Bed Letter
Keys and Indicators
4. Press the Patient Info. Up or Down Arrow
key (27 & 28) to increment or decrement
the bed letter.
5. Press the ROOM/BED key a third time
to exit this mode, or do not press the
key for 15 seconds.
Once measurements have been taken, and the
unit is powered off and on, the room number
and bed letter will default to the lowest room
and bed where data is currently stored.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
1-19
1.3.3
MANUAL NIBP MEASUREMENTS AND GENERAL NIBP
MEASUREMENT INFORMATION
1. Select a pressure cuff that is appropriate for the size of the patient. Use the chart below
as a guideline.
Limb Circumference (cm)
Disposable Cuffs - Latex Free
30 - 45
24 - 36
18 - 27
16 - 25
Description / Cuff Name
Datascope Part Number
Large Adult
Adult
Child
Small Child
0683-07-0001-01
0683-07-0001-02
0683-07-0001-03
0683-07-0001-04
Disposable Neonatal Cuffs (box of 10)
Approximate Limb Circumference:
Size 0: 5 - 8 cm
Size 1: 7 - 10 cm
Size 2: 9 - 13 cm
Size 3: 12 - 17 cm
0683-03-0004-01
0683-03-0001-01
0683-03-0002-01
0683-03-0003-01
Color Coded Cuffs** - Reusable Cuffs
45 - 66
30 - 47
24 - 36
18 - 27
6 - 11
Thigh - Tan*
Large Adult - Gray
Adult - Brown
Child - Red
New Born - Blue
Infant
0998-00-0003-36
0998-00-0003-35
0998-00-0003-34
0998-00-0003-33
0998-00-0003-31
0998-00-0003-32
A cuff that is too small for the limb will result in erroneously high readings. The correct
size of the pressure cuff for a given patient has, among other considerations, a direct
bearing on the accuracy of the obtained NIBP measurements. Base your selection of the
cuff size on the limb circumference of the patient. The table above indicates the available
Datascope cuffs for use with the Accutorr Plus. The design dimensions of the cuffs and
their intended uses are based on recommendations of the American Heart Association.
NOTE: The cuffs that are used with the Accutorr Plus use special snap on connectors.
Adapter hoses are available to connect older style cuff connectors. See Optional Accessories,
Section 5.2 in the Operating Instructions for a detailed list of cuffs and adapter hoses.
WARNING: Use only Datascope cuffs. Use of other than Datascope cuffs may result in
erroneous measurements.
The pressure on the limb may not fall to zero between measurements if the cuff is
wrapped too tightly. Therefore, assure that the cuff is properly applied.
The skin is sometimes fragile (i.e., on pediatrics, geriatrics, etc.). In these cases, a longer
timer interval should be considered to decrease the number of cuff inflations over a period
of time. NOTE: In extreme cases, a thin layer of soft roll or webril cotton padding
may be applied to the limb in order to cushion the skin when the cuff is inflated. This
measure may affect NIBP performance and should be used with caution.
*
**
1-20
When using the thigh cuff, this product may not comply with product specifications listed in chapter 3.
The limb circumferences of the color coded cuffs adhere to the AHA guidelines for size. They also incorporate
index and range lines to assist in cuff selection. The cuff bladder and hose contain Natural Latex rubber.
The bladder has a dacron cover.
Revised 06/25/99
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
2. Attach the cuff hose to the NIBP cuff connector (18). To do this, hold the hose behind
the knurled pressure fitting (female). Push onto the male connector until a click is
heard. To remove, hold the knurled female fitting and pull firmly to release.
3. Apply the cuff to the patient. To reduce errors, the cuff should fit snugly, but with
enough room for two fingers to be placed between the cuff and the patient’s arm (on
adults), and with little or no air present within the cuff. Cuff should fit loosely on
neonates. Apply the cuff so that the center of the inflation bag (bladder) is over the
brachial artery. Be sure that the INDEX line on the cuff falls between the two
RANGE lines. If not, a larger or smaller cuff is required. Be sure the cuff lies directly
against the patient’s skin. For best results, the cuff should be placed on the arm at
heart level and no clothing should come between the patient and the cuff. NOTE:
Avoid compression or restriction of the pressure hose.
NOTE: The NIBP cuff should not be placed on a limb that is being utilized for any
other medical procedure. For example, an I.V. catheter.
4. If required, select the patient size with the PATIENT SETUP key (37). On initial power
up, the configurable default setting is used. Otherwise, the last selected patient size is
used. Initial default cuff inflation pressures depend on the Patient Size setting. See
section 1.3.2.2 for details on changing the initial cuff inflation pressure.
5. Press the START NIBP key (38) to begin an NIBP measurement. A beep is sounded
after a completed measurement.
NOTE: Inflate the cuff only after proper application to the patient’s limb. Cuff
damage can result if the cuff is left unwrapped and then inflated.
The cuff begins to inflate to the selected cuff pressure. After reaching the
selected pressure, the cuff begins to slowly deflate and the Accutorr Plus collects
oscillometric pulsations.
If the initial cuff inflation is found to be inadequate, the unit retries with a higher
inflation pressure (+50 mmHg in the adult mode; +50 in the pediatric mode; +40
mmHg in the neonate mode). A triple beep tone is generated. NOTE: Any time there
is an unsuccessful NIBP measurement, a triple beep tone is generated and the Diastolic,
Systolic, NIBP HR, MAP and Timer/Temp LED’s will be replaced with dashes.
Have the patient remain still to avoid unnecessary motion artifact. After the cuff
pressure drops below the diastolic pressure, the results of the measurement are
displayed and the cuff is vented to atmosphere.
If an error code displays in the Systolic Display or a status code in the Room/Bed
Display, refer to Section 1.3.16, Status and Error Codes, for its explanation. A
successful measurement clears a status code. To clear a status code, press the
ROOM/BED NUMBER key (24).
6. When required, press the DEFLATE key (36) to interrupt a measurement. The cuff will
deflate.
NOTE: Once the initial measurement is taken for a room/bed, the Accutorr Plus will
continue to use the selected patient size.
NOTE: Check the patient’s limb for any indications of circulation impairment.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
1-21
1.3.3.1 NIBP Pres sure Limit Fail Safe
If the cuff is over-pressurized, it will automatically deflate and the status code 8812
(STOP - CUFF OVERPRESSURE) or error code 987 (STOP - HARDWARE
OVERPRESSURE) will be displayed in the Room/Bed or display.
The unit must be turned off and back on again to reset the hardware overpressure switch
(error code 987) before any new measurements can be taken.
1.3.3.2 Cuff In fla tion Time
If the cuff pressure does not attain 20 mmHg within 40 seconds of the start of inflation
or if the target pressure is not reached within another 60 seconds, then the cuff is deflated
and status codes will be displayed in the Room/Bed display. See section 1.3.16 for a list of
error and status codes.
1.3.3.3 Au to matic Ad just ment of Cuff In fla tion Pres sure (Adaptive
Inflation)
The unit adjusts the inflation pressure according to the previous reading of the systolic
pressure. After the first successful measurement, the inflation pressure is the previous
systolic +50 mmHg in the adult mode and +50 mmHg in the pediatric mode and +40
mmHg in the neonate mode. When not in interval mode, the adaptive inflation may be
disabled.
To view the current inflation pressure, press and hold (2 beep tones, approximately 3
seconds) the Patient Setup Key (37). The current inflation pressure is shown in the MAP
display. If required, use the Patient Info. Up & Down Arrow keys (27 & 28) to change
the inflation pressure.
It is also possible to permanently override this adjustment in the User Configuration. See
section 1.3.15 for details.
1-22
Revised 05/22/02
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
1.3.4
AUTOMATIC NIBP MEASUREMENTS (Interval Mode)
The Accutorr Plus can be set to automatically take NIBP measurements. On initial
power up, the interval setting will default to OFF. The User Configuration mode can be
used to set custom defaults for the Interval Mode. See section 1.3.15, User Configuration
for details. In this mode, the adaptive inflation is always enabled.
Follow Steps 1 - 4 in the Manual Procedure, Section 1.3.3, to select, attach and apply the
cuff and to adjust the initial cuff inflation pressure.
5. Press the INTERVAL key (34). The current selection is displayed in the Interval/
Elap.Time/Temp. display (33). Press the INTERVAL key to scroll to the next available
interval selection. The selections are: Off (—- when set to graphic display), CONT
(continuous), 1, 2.5, 5, 10, 15, 20, 30, 60, 120 and 240 minutes. When an interval
setting is selected, except for Off, the Interval Indicator (35) flashes. When the interval
mode is activated the Interval Indicator illuminates continuously.
6. The displayed interval time is entered when the INTERVAL key has not been pressed
for 15 seconds or,
when the TIMER/TEMP key (32) is pressed, which changes the display back to Elap. Time
or, when the START NIBP key (38) is pressed, which initiates an NIBP measurement, activates the Interval Mode, and changes the display back to Elap. Time.
7. If the START NIBP key (38) has not already been pressed, press to take a measurement
and to activate the interval mode. NOTE: If the interval time is changed, the START
NIBP key does not need to be pressed for the new interval to initiate. When the new
time interval has elapsed, a measurement will be taken.
NOTE: When the NIBP continuous interval is chosen, the Accutorr Plus will take back
to back (one right after the other) blood pressure readings. As a safety precaution, a five
minute limit is placed on continuous measurements. After 5 minutes, the NIBP interval
will automatically switch to measurements taken once every 5 minutes. This is done to
reduce the chance of surface vessel rupture (petechia).
If it is desirable to maintain a fixed cuff inflation pressure, the adaptive inflation feature
may be disabled in this “continuous” mode.
1.3.4.1 Can celing an Au to matic NIBP Mea sure ment
To cancel a scheduled measurement, press the DEFLATE key (36). This will suspend the
timed NIBP measurements until the START NIBP key (38) is pressed. The interval
indicator will flash. See section 1.3.4.4 for more details on the start and deflate function.
NOTE: Pressing the DEFLATE key (36) will also end a measurement cycle that is
already in progress.
To take an immediate measurement and to reactivate the Interval mode, press the START
NIBP key (38). The next timed measurement will be taken at the time set by the interval.
For example, if the interval was set to 30 minutes, the next timed measurement will be
30 minutes after the START NIBP key was pressed. NOTE: If the Interval mode is no
longer required, set the interval to “OFF” prior to pressing the START NIBP key. See
section 3.4 for details on changing the interval mode.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
Revised 05/22/02
1-23
NOTE: If the DEFLATE key (36) is pressed, it will take 10 seconds before another
measurement can be taken. The START NIBP INDICATOR (39) will be illuminated,
when ready.
NOTE: When in the Interval mode and the Room/Bed is changed, the interval mode is
suspended (interval indicator flashes) until the NIBP Start key is pressed.
1.3.4.2 Changing the Interval Setting
If the interval time is changed while the Accutorr Plus is in the interval mode, the new
interval time is used once it is entered. For example: The interval time is set to 60
minutes. Thirty minutes have elapsed since the last timed automatic measurement and
the interval time is changed to 10 minutes. Once the interval time is entered, the
Accutorr Plus will take an automatic NIBP measurement in 10 minutes and then once
every 10 minutes.
1.3.4.3 Effects of Changing the Room Number and/or Bed Letter on
the Interval Setting
When the Room Number and/or Bed Letter is changed, the interval setting will remain
the same. NOTE: The interval setting can be changed if required. Also, if an NIBP
measurement is in progress, the measurement will stop and the cuff will deflate. The
timed interval measurements will not activate again (interval indicator flashes) until the
START NIBP key (38) is pressed.
1.3.4.4 START and DEFLATE Functions
The START NIBP and DEFLATE functions have the following effects on the timed
measurement sequence.
· INTERVAL mode is active and the START NIBP key (38) is pressed causing an
unscheduled measurement to be taken. Taking this unscheduled measurement does not
affect the timing of the interval cycle, therefore, the scheduled measurements will still be
taken as if there were no interruptions. Only one measurement is taken for each
measurement cycle - even if the unscheduled measurement coincides with the scheduled
measurement.
· INTERVAL mode is active and the DEFLATE key (36) is pressed. The INTERVAL
INDICATOR (35) flashes. No additional measurements will be taken until the START
NIBP key (38) is pressed. If a timed measurement is in progress, the measurement is
suspended and the cuff deflates.
· INTERVAL mode is active and the interval time is changed. The measurement cycle is
reset with the new interval. A measurement will be taken after the new interval time has
elapsed.
1-24
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
1.3.5
ALARMS
The Accutorr Plus provides “HI” and “LO” alarm limit settings for systolic, diastolic,
MAP, pulse rate and SpO2. An alarm violation occurs when one or more patient
parameters equals or falls outside the limits that have been specified.
1.3.5.1 Setting Alarm Limits
The Factory Default for all parameter alarms, except Low SpO2, is OFF. The Low SpO2
factory default is 86. The User Configuration mode can be used to set custom defaults.
See section 1.3.15, User Configuration for details. The factory and custom defaults for
alarms can be changed as required to accommodate the needs of individual patients. The
SET ALARMS key (29) and the Patient Info. Up and Down Arrow keys (27 & 28) are
used to set alarm values.
1. Press the SET ALARMS key (29) (1 beep) to enter into the alarm set mode.
The first time this key is pressed, all NIBP displays blank except for the systolic
display which shows the current high systolic alarm value. The word HI is displayed
in the Interval/Elap. Time/Temp display (33). When the unit has been configured to
display graphics, the symbol
is displayed. When the graphic is displayed, the
top lines blink. This indicates the high alarm is selected.
The second time the SET ALARMS key (29) is pressed the Systolic LO parameter is
selected. The word LO is displayed in the Interval/Elap. Time/Temp display (33).
When the unit has been configured to display graphics, the symbol
is
displayed. When the graphic is displayed, the bottom lines blink. This indicates the
low alarm is selected.
Each time the SET ALARMS key (29) is pressed a new parameter is selected for alarm
setting (all other displays blank). The order they are available is: Systolic HI, Systolic
LO, Diastolic HI, Diastolic LO, MAP HI, MAP LO, Pulse Rate HI, and Pulse Rate
LO, SpO2 HI and SpO2 LO. When all of the available parameters have been selected,
the next press of the SET ALARMS key returns the Accutorr Plus to normal
operation.
2. To change an alarm limit setting, use the Patient Info. Up & Down Arrow keys (27 &
28). The Up arrow increments the alarm limit setting. The Down arrow decrements
the alarm limit setting.
To cancel all of the changed alarm values while still in progress of changing, press the
DEFAULTS key (14) (1 beep tone).
If the SET ALARMS or Arrow keys have not been pressed for 15 seconds, the
Accutorr Plus returns to normal operation and saves any alarm limit changes.
NOTE: If the patient size is changed, the alarm settings will change to the default
settings for the new patient size.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
Revised 12/20/00
1-25
Alarm Limit Table
PARAMETER
Systolic High
Adult
Pediatric
Neonate
Systolic Low
Adult
Pediatric
Neonate
Diastolic High
Adult
Pediatric
Neonate
Diastolic Low
Adult
Pediatric
Neonate
MAP High
Adult
Pediatric
Neonate
MAP Low
Adult
Pediatric
Neonate
Pulse Rate High
Adult
Pediatric
Neonate
Pulse Rate Low
Adult
Pediatric
Neonate
SpO2 High
Adult
Pediatric
Neonate
SpO2 Low
Adult
Pediatric
Neonate
RANGE
UNITS
FACTORY
DEFAULT
UNITS OF
INCREMENT
Off, 60-260
Off, 60-160
Off, 50-125
mmHg
Off
5
Off, 55-150
Off, 55-130
Off, 45-115
mmHg
Off
5
Off, 40-200
Off, 40-150
Off, 35-100
mmHg
Off
5
Off, 30-120
Off, 30-50
Off, 25-50
mmHg
Off
5
Off, 90-200
Off, 90-150
Off, 60-110
mmHg
Off
5
Off, 40-100
Off, 40-70
Off, 30-70
mmHg
Off
5
Off, 100-245
Off, 100-245
Off, 100-245
bpm
Off
5
Off, 35-120
Off, 35-150
Off, 75-200
bpm
Off
5
Off, 61-99
Off, 61-99
Off,61-99
%SpO2
Off
1
60-95
60-95
60-95
%SpO2
86
1
1.3.5.2 Alarm Violations
An alarm condition exists if the parameter is equal to or is outside the high/low limit
range that has been set. When an alarm limit is violated, the following actions occur:
· The LEDs for the parameter in an alarm condition flashes.
· The parameter in an alarm condition is in reverse video on the LCD (Accutorr Plus models
with Trend Screen).
· The alarm tone is sounded (unless muted with the MUTE key (30)).
· The parameter(s) that was in an alarm condition will be in brackets [ ] when printed on
the recorder.
1-26
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
1.3.5.3 How to Mute Alarms
When an NIBP alarm exists, press the MUTE key (30) (1 beep tone) to silence the alarm
tone for 2 minutes. The alarm tone will return after the next measurement value that
violates the selected limits.
When an SpO2 alarm exists, press the MUTE key (30) (1 beep tone) to silence the alarm
tone for two minutes. The alarm tone will return after two minutes, unless the SpO2
value changes and is within the alarm limits. If during that two minutes the measured
SpO2 value changes to a value that is within the acceptable range, and then returns to
a value that is outside the set alarm limit, the alarm tone will return before the two
minutes elapse. Example (within 2 minutes): • SpO2 low alarm limit has been set to 90.
• SpO2 is measured at 89; the alarm tone sounds and the SpO2 display flashes. • The
MUTE key is pressed. • SpO2 is measured at 88; there is no alarm tone, but the SpO2
display flashes. • SpO2 is measured at 91; no alarm tone sounds and the display stops
flashing. • SpO2 is measured at 89; the alarm tone sounds and the SpO2 display flashes.
Press and hold the MUTE key (30) (2 beep tones, approx. 3 seconds) to permanently
silence the alarm tone. The MUTE LED (31) illuminated. The LEDs for the alarming
parameter will continue to flash. To reactivate the alarm tone function, press the MUTE
key (30) again.
1.3.5.4 Alarms and Changing the Room Num ber and/or Bed Let ter
When changing the rooms and beds, the alarm settings will change if the final room/bed
displayed is a different patient size than the original room/bed. When a new patient size is
detected, the alarm settings change to the defaults for the different patient size. See section
1.3.15 for information on custom defaults.
The table below describes 6 measurements in different rooms/beds and different patient
sizes, and the effect on the alarm settings.
Measurement Order
Room/Bed
Patient Size
Alarm Settings
1
2
3
1/a
1/b
2/a
Adult
Adult
Pediatric
4
3/a
Adult
5
6
4/a
1/a
Adult
Adult
Have been manually set.
Remain the same.
Changed to defaults for a
pediatric size patient.
Changed to defaults for an adult
size patient.
Remain the same.
Remain the same. If the alarm
settings that were set from the
1st measurement are required,
they need to be set again
manually.
NOTE: The alarm settings can be changed, if necessary, when changing the room/bed
and the patient size is the same.
PRECAUTION: It is the users responsibility, when changing the room/bed, to assure the patient
size and alarm settings are as required.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
Revised 05/22/02
1-27
1.3.6
TO VIEW AND DELETE STORED DATA (Trend Mode)
All models of the Accutorr Plus are capable of storing up to 100 entries of measurement
data. Each time a successful NIBP measurement is made, the data is automatically stored
in memory. When a temperature measurement is made between two minutes before and
two minutes after an NIBP measurement, it is stored as the same entry with the NIBP
measurement. If a temperature measurement is made outside this time, it is stored as a
separate entry. When either NIBP or temperature measurements are stored and SpO2
information is available, then the SpO2 data is also stored.
When 80 entries are stored into trend memory, the MEMORY FULL Indicator (20) will
flash. When 100 entries are stored into trend memory, the MEMORY FULL Indicator
(20) will illuminate continuously. Once 100 entries are stored, old data can be deleted
manually for any patient; or when new data is available, the Accutorr Plus will
automatically delete the oldest data for the currently displayed patient.
NOTE: The unit will also automatically delete data that is 24 hours old.
The Accutorr Plus NIBP uses the Systolic, Diastolic, MAP, and Temp displays to view
stored data. The Accutorr Plus models with Trend Screen use the LCD to display up to 5
measurements at a time. The stored data that is viewed is for the currently selected
patient (indicated by the room number/bed letter).
1.3.6.1 To View the Stored Measurements on the Accutorr Plus NIBP
1. Press the DATA SCAN key (22) (1 beep tone). The DATA SCAN Indicator (23)
illuminates.
2. Press the Patient Info. Up and Down Arrow keys (27 & 28) to view stored data for the
current patient. The stored data is displayed in the Systolic, Diastolic, MAP, Pulse
Rate and Temp displays.
Consecutive presses or pressing and holding the UP or DOWN arrow will
allow the stored measurements to continuously wrap around. When the measurements
wrap, a double beep tone will sound. If a temperature measurement is not available
for the NIBP measurement that is displayed, then - - - - is shown in the Interval/Elap.
Time/Temp display (33). To view the time of measurements, press the TIME/TEMP
key (32).
3. To exit the view stored data mode, press the DATA SCAN key (22) (1 beep).
1-28
Revised 12/20/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
1.3.6.2 To View the Stored Measurements on the Accutorr Plus NIBP with Trend
Screen and the Accutorr Plus NIBP with Trend Screen and SpO2
The stored measurements on the Accutorr Plus models with Trend Screen are displayed in the
LCD. Up to 5 stored measurements are displayed at one time. Measurements are displayed in
time order, with the newest measurement at the top. A scroll bar with one or both arrows will
display on the side of the LCD when more measurements are available to view. When only
one arrow displays, more measurements are only available in the direction of the arrow.
1. To view more measurements press the LCD Up or Down Arrow key (9 & 10).
Time
Date
20/05
20/05
20/05
20/05
20/05
03:00
02:58
02:35
02:33
02:30
S / D /
114/64
123/61
127/62
185/105
129/62
M
83
84
83
135
84
F/C %SPO2
96
98.7
97
98.5
96
97.6
96
---98.2
97
o
61
60
58
56
59
Scroll
Bar
Alarm Violated Measurement
Figure 1-10 - LCD Trend List Display
1.3.6.3 To Delete the Stored Measurements on all Models of the Accutorr Plus
While viewing stored data, you can delete the most recent measurement or all of the
stored measurements for the currently displayed patient.
1. Select a room/bed where stored information can be deleted. (See section 1.3.2.3 for
details on selecting a room/bed.) If it is the currently displayed room/bed, go to step
2. When you are uncertain what rooms/beds have stored data, press and hold the
DATA SCAN key (22) (2 beep tones, more than 3 seconds). The Accutorr Plus will
scan through all of the rooms/beds that have data stored. To stop on a Room/Bed as
the Accutorr Plus is scanning, press the DATA SCAN key (22). NOTE: The Accutorr
Plus will scan through the rooms/bed with stored data only once.
2. On the Accutorr Plus NIBP only, when the desired room/bed is displayed, press the
DATA SCAN key (22) (1 beep tone). The DATA SCAN Indicator (23) illuminates.
3. When the most recent stored data is displayed, press and hold the DELETE INFO.
key (21) (1 beep tone, approx. 3 seconds) to delete this measurement.
4. When viewing any of the stored measurements, press and hold the DELETE INFO.
key (21) (2 beep tones, approx. 6 seconds) to delete all stored measurements for the
current patient. When all data is cleared the patient size will be the default selection.
5. On the Accutorr Plus NIBP only, press the DATA SCAN key (22) (1 beep tone) to
exit the delete data mode.
NOTE: The unit will also automatically delete data that is 24 hours old.
NOTE: To delete all information for all patients, press and hold the DELETE INFO. key
(21) while powering on the unit.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
1-29
1.3.7
SETTING THE ALARM VOLUME AND BEEP VOLUME
The LCD on the Accutorr Plus models with Trend Screen is used to display the Trend
List as described in section 1.3.6. It is also used to display a menu which is used to set
the alarm volume and the SpO2 beep volume. The MENU key (8), the LCD Up and
Down Arrow keys (9 & 10), and the SELECT key (12) are used to set these volumes. The
User Configuration mode can be used to set custom defaults for the alarm volume and
beep volume. See section 1.3.15, User Configuration for details.
1. Press the MENU key (8) to display the menu. The menu is shown in figure 3-4. The
alarm volume is initially highlighted when the menu is displayed. The highlighting
indicates this item can be changed.
2. Press the LCD Up and Down Arrow keys (9 & 10) to change the current selection for
the alarm volume. The selections are: OFF, 1, 2, 3, 4, and 5 with 5 being the loudest.
3. Press the SELECT key (11) to move the highlighting to SpO 2 beep volume.
4. Press the LCD Up and Down Arrow keys (9 & 10) to change the current selection for
the SpO2 volume. The selections are: OFF, 1, 2, 3, 4, and 5 with 5 being the loudest.
5. Press the MENU key (8) again to exit the menu and return to the Trend screen.
NOTE: Any changes made to the alarm volume or the SpO2 volume will be erased when
the unit is turned off and then back on again. Also, any changes made (except off) will
restore and enable the alarm tone, regardless of prior mute condition.
Alarm Volume
SpO2 Beep
Volume
3
3
Figure 1-11 Menu
1-30
Revised 05/22/02
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
1.3.8
SETTING THE LCD CONTRAST (View Angle Adjustment)
The LCD on the Accutorr Plus models with Trend Screen can be adjusted for optimum
viewing. The MENU key (8) and the LCD Up and Down Arrow keys (9 & 10) are used
to adjust the contrast.
1. Press and hold the MENU key (8) (2 beep tones, approx. 3 seconds). A beep tone is
generated when the key is first pressed and the display changes to the menu. When a
second beep tone is generated, release the key.
2. To quickly adjust the contrast, press and hold either the LCD Up or Down Arrow
key (9 or 10). For fine adjustment, momentarily press either the LCD Up or Down
Arrow key.
3. The LCD contrast adjustment is saved by either pressing the MENU key (8) again or
not pressing either the LCD UP or Down Arrow keys (9 & 10) for 15 seconds.
NOTE: The contrast setting will be the same each time the unit is turned on, unless
readjusted by the user.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
1-31
1.3.9
DISPLAY TIME OUT MODE
To conserve power, most displays will blank at user selected times. The LCD illumination
time out can be set between 3 and 15 minutes. The LED display time out can be set
between 5 and 60 minutes. Since the Accutorr Plus can be powered from either an AC or
DC source, the user configuration allows the setting of separate times for each type of
power source. See User Configuration, section 1.3.15 for more information on setting the
time out minutes.
To turn on the LCD light, press the MENU key (8). To turn on the LED displays, press
any key.
1-32
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
1.3.10 SpO2 MEASUREMENTS (Accutorr Plus model with SpO2)
To obtain SpO2 measurements and SpO2 Heart Rate from the Accutorr Plus model with SpO2:
See Section 3.10.1 for units with Datascope SpO2; for units with Nellcor SpO2 see
section 3.10.2; for units with Masimo SpO2 see section 1.3.10.3)
CAUTION: Do not place the sensor on an extremity with an invasive catheter or blood pressure
cuff in place.
CAUTION: A pulse oximeter should not be used as an apeana mnitor.
CAUTION: A pulse oximeter should be considered an early warning device. As a trend towards
patient deoxygenation is indicated, blood samples should be analyzed by a laboratory co-oximeter to
completely understand the patient’s condition.
CAUTION: Ensure proper routing of the patient cable to avoid entanglement and/or strangulation
NOTE: In the event you are unable to obtain a reading, or the reading is inaccurate,
check the patients vital signs by alternate means and consider the following:
· If your patient is poorly perfused, try applying the sensor to another site (i.e. A
different finger or toe).
· Check that the sensor is properly aligned.
· In electrosurgery, make sure the sensor is not too close to ESU devices or cables.
· Check to make sure the site area is clean / non-greasy. Clean the site and sensor if
needed. Nail polish and fungus should be removed.
1.3.10.1
Datascope Pulse Oximetry Sensors
A. Introduction
A wide range of Datascope sensors are available for connection to the Accutorr Plus
model with SpO2. The sensors cover both short-term and long-term monitoring needs on
patients ranging from infants to large adults.
The DATASENSOR is intended for short-term adult monitoring.
The FLEXISENSOR® SD, available in five different sizes, provides both short-term and
long-term monitoring for large adults, adult ear, adults, pediatrics, and infants. The
FLEXISENSOR® SD is used when the DATASENSOR is not convenient or suitable.
The ear sensor is intended for long-term adult monitoring. A range of disposable bandages
are available for use with the FLEXISENSOR® SDs. They are available in 2styles, SENSOR
GUARD™ (used for large adults, adults and pediatrics), and Coban with SENSOR
GUARD™ (used for infants).
Use of the sensors does not cause any penetration of the skin, nor is there any electrical
contact or transfer of excessive heat to the patient.
The sensor is composed of a dual light emitting diode (LED) (emitter) and a photo
diode (detector). The emitter discharges two colors (wave lengths) of light into the
patient’s extremity (finger, toe, ear). The detector receives the light not absorbed by the
blood or tissue components. The Accutorr Plus model with SpO2 then uses the
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
Revised 02/15/00
1-33
relative absorption of the two light wavelengths to compute and display SpO2 (functional
saturation) and Pulse Rate measurements.
The key benefits of the sensors are:
· Electro-Surgical Noise (ESU) Rejection - The sensor configuration of both the
DATASENSOR and the FLEXISENSOR® SD provide uninterrupted monitoring and
absence of false alarms during the use of ESU (ESU can be set at any power level). This
design prevents electro-surgical noise entering the monitor, via the sensor, and interfering with unit operation.
· Monitoring Restless Patients - Motion artifact rejection is achieved in several ways.
1. The sensor design used with their recommended bandages assures a snug fit of
the sensor to the patient.
2. Light emitting diodes (LEDs) and detectors gather a strong signal from the patient.
3. When in the presence of motion, the software adjusts the “averaging-period”,
increasing it to a maximum of 15 seconds during motion, and automatically
reducing it during quiet periods to obtain a fast response. This combination
reduces the number of monitoring interruptions and false alarms from patient motion.
· Tracking of Weak Peripheral Pulse Levels - Many patients suffer poor peripheral
perfusion due to hypothermia, hypovolemia, reduced cardiac output, etc. The Accutorr
Plus model with SpO2 is designed to automatically increase its gain to track patients with
poor peripheral perfusion.
· Rejection of Ambient Light - Many monitoring situations involve high levels of
ambient light, i.e.., operating room lights, neonatal phototherapy, heat warmers, etc. The
Accutorr Plus model with SpO2, the sensors, and the bandages each contribute to the
rejection of ambient light. The monitor automatically measures and corrects for high
levels of ambient light. The enclosed design of the DATASENSOR prohibits the interference
of high levels of ambient light on adults with sensor operation. The opaque material used
in the composition of the bandages, which are used with the FLEXISENSOR® SD, helps
keep out ambient light.
®
· Patient Comfort - The FLEXISENSOR SD line is designed to work with a disposable
bandage of two styles (SENSOR GUARD TM and Coban) which conform comfortably
and safely to the particular patient’s anatomy.
B. Sensor Selection and Application
Selection of a specific sensor is based on the patient’s size, physical condition, and expected
monitoring duration. General guidelines for the selection of a sensor are provided in the
Sensor Selection Table, page 3-25. Instructions for the application of a sensor to a patient
are provided in each sensor package. For optimal DATASENSOR and FLEXISENSOR®
placement ensure that cable side is placed in the correct position. See figures below.
Cable on Top
Figure 1-12 Datasensor or
Durasensor Placement
1-34
Revised 02/15/00
Cable on Bottom
Figure 1-13 FlexisensorÞ Placement
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
C. Sensor Connection to the Accutorr Plus model with SpO2
1. Align the cable connector on the sensor assembly with the SpO2 Connector (15) on
the Accutorr Plus model with SpO2.
2. Push the cable connector into the SpO2 Connector (15). Confirm that the cable
connector is securely in place.
3. The digital SpO2 values and SpO2 pulse rate will be displayed in the SpO2 and pulse
Rate LED’s.
4. If desired, adjust the beep volume. See section 3.7, Setting the Alarm Volume and
Beep Volume, for details on adjusting the beep volume.
D. Sensor Inspection
Before use, always inspect sensors, cables, and connectors for damage, i.e., cuts and abrasions.
Do not use the sensor, cable or connector if damaged. Replace with a good working sensor.
For long sensor life:
· Do not drop on the floor, or give other sharp shocks to the sensor(s). Between use, store the
sensors in the accessory pouch, or coil the sensor cable and store on the side of the Accutorr
Plus rolling stand using the optional cable retainer. For accessory part number information
see Section 5.2, “Optional Accessories”.
· Avoid running any cart, bed, or any piece of equipment over the sensor cable.
· Avoid strong pulls on the sensor cable (10 lbs/4kg).
· Watch for cracks in the DATASENSOR housing.
®
· Watch for cracks, cuts, rips, fogging, or signs of moisture in the FLEXISENSOR SD
E. Sensor Performance
For the BEST performance:
· DO NOT PLACE any sensor on an extremity with an arterial catheter or blood
pressure cuff in place. Placement of an arterial catheter or blood pressure cuff on an
extremity may obstruct normal blood flow. False pulse rate information may result if the
FLEXISENSOR® SD is placed on that same extremity. Place the sensor on the limb
opposite the site of the arterial catheter or blood pressure cuff.
· Encourage the patient to remain still. Patient motion may affect the sensor’s performance. If it
is not possible for the patient to remain still, replace the sensor bandage on the
FLEXISENSOR® SD to assure good adhesion, or change the site of the DATASENSOR.
®
· Check the DATASENSOR site every 2 hours and check the FLEXISENSOR SD site
every 8 hours for indications of skin abrasions, sensor displacement, sensor damage, or
circulation impairment. Check the sensor site every 4 hours if the ear clip is used. If
necessary, remove and reapply the sensor. If any of the above mentioned indications occur,
immediately remove the sensor and find an alternate site. NOTE: Check the sensor site
more frequently on infant and active patients.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
Revised 02/15/00
1-35
· Incorrect placement can also reduce the acquired sensor signal, and therefore compromise
performance. Select an alternate site (toe) or use a FLEXISENSOR® SD if the sensor can
not be placed on the patient’s finger correctly or if the fingernails interfere with the
acquisition of a reliable signal.
· Use of the DATASENSOR is not recommended for long-term monitoring (4-6 hours). For
monitoring situations exceeding 4-6 hours, either reposition the DATASENSOR every
2-4 hours to a different site (finger/toe) or use a FLEXISENSOR® SD with its appropriate
bandage.
· Do not over-tighten the sensor bandages. Excessive pressure on the monitoring site can
affect SpO2 readings and may reduce readings below true SpO2. Excessive pressure can
also result in pressure necrosis and other skin damage.
· Sensor configuration provides virtually uninterrupted monitoring during following
situations:
Electro-cautery Noise - Electro-cautery noise rejection is designed into the sensors.
Motion Artifact - The monitor’s software adjusts the “averaging period” increasing it
during motion and reducing it during inactivity. This decreases the number of
monitoring interruptions and false alarms.
Weak Peripheral Pulses - The monitor’s gain is automatically increased to track
pulses on patients with decreased peripheral perfusion.
Datascope SpO2 Sensor Selection Table
Sensors
Large
Adult (LA)
>80kg/
>176 lbs
Adult
(A)
0 - 90kg/
66 - 198
lbs
Where Used
Fingers,
Toes
Fingers,
Toes
Pediatric
(P)
10 40kg/
22 - 88
lbs
Fingers,
Toes
Long or Short
Term Monitoring
Electro-Surgical
Interference
Suppression
(ESIS)
Reusable
Long &
Short
Term
Included
Long &
Short
Term
Included
Long &
Short
Term
Included
Approximate
Patient Weight
Yes Up to Yes Up to Yes Up
20 Uses
20 Uses
to 20
Uses
Bandage Type
Adhesive, Adhesive, Adhesive,
Disposable Disposable Disposable
Part
Sensors 0998-00-0 0998-00- 0998-00#’s**
076-06
0076-05 0076-04
Bandages 0683-00-0 0683-00- 0683-00409-01
0409-02 0409-03
Infant
(I)
4.5 10kg/
10 - 22
lbs
Feet,
Palms,
Big Toes
Long &
Short
Term
Included
Yes Up
to 20
Uses
NonAdhesive*
0998-000074-03
0683-000415
Adult
Datasensor
Ear (AE)
>40kg/ 40+ kg/
>88 lbs 90+ lbs
Adult
Ear
Fingers, Toes
Long & Short Term
Short
Term
Included Included
Yes Up Yes
to 20
6-Months
Uses
Adhesive Disposable
0998-00- 0600-00-0026-01
0074-05 (3’ sensor cable)***
N/A
N/A
* <Non-adhesive bandages are recommended for premature infants to minimize prenatal skin damage.
** See Accessories, Chapter 5, for more detailed information.
*** Additional choices: 0060-00-0026-02 (10’ sensor cable), 0020-00-0071-01
(3’ sensor cable plus 7’ extension cable).
1-36
Revised 02/15/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
1.3.10.2 Sequence for establishing SpO2 with Nellcorâ Pulse Oximetry*
* This feature applicable only if available or installed on your unit.
1.Select the appropriate sensor for the patient from Page 3-28
2. Plug the sensor directly into the SpO2 connector (15) or if necessary, use a Nellcorâ
SC10 extension cable. NOTE: Do not place the sensor on an extremity with an invasive
catheter or blood pressure cuff in place.
CAUTION:
When equipped with Nellcorâ SpO2, use only Nellcorâ oxygen transducers
including Nellcorâ Oxisensorä patient dedicated adhesive sensors. Use of other
oxygen transducers may cause improper oximeter performance.
CAUTION:
Tissue damage or inaccurate measurements may be caused by incorrect sensor
application or use, such as wrapping it too tightly, applying supplemental tape,
failing to inspect the sensor site periodically, or failing to position it appropriately.
Carefully read the sensor directions for use, the Accutorr Plus operating
instructions, and all precautionary information before use.
CAUTION:
Excessive ambient light may cause inaccurate measurements. Cover the sensor
with opaque materials.
CAUTION:
Inaccurate readings may be caused by incorrect sensor application or use;
significant levels of dysfunctional hemoglobins, (i.e. carbohemoglobins or
methemoglobin); or intra-vascular dyes such as indocyanine green methylene blue;
exposure to excessive illumination, such as surgical lamps (especially ones with a
Xenon light source), bilirubin lamps, florescent lights, infrared heating lamps,
or direct sunlight; excessive patient movement; venous pulsations; electro-surgical
interference; and placement of a sensor on an extremity that has a blood pressure
cuff, arterial catheter, or intra-vascular line.
CAUTION:
In certain situations in which perfusion and signal strength are low, such as in
patients with thick or pigmented skin, inaccurately low SpO2 readings will
result. Verification of oxygenation should be made, especially in preterm infants
and patients with chronic lung disease, before instituting any therapy or
interventation.
CAUTION:
If the sensor or patient cable is damaged in any way, discontinue use
immediately. To prevent damage do not soak or immerse the sensor in any liquid
solution. DO NOT ATTEMPT TO STERILIZE.
3. The digital SpO2 value and SpO2 Pulse Rate will be displayed on the SpO2 and Pulse
Rate LED’s.
4. If desired, adjust the beep volume. See Section 3.7, “Setting the Alarm Volume and
Beep Volume”, for details on adjusting the beep volume.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
Revised 02/15/00
1-37
1.3.10.2.1 NELLCOR ® Sensors
NELLCOR® provides a family of sensors suitable for a wide variety of clinical settings
and patients. Specific sensors have been developed for neonates, infants, children, and adults.
OXISENSOR™ oxygen transducers are sterile adhesive sensors with optical components
mounted on adhesive tape. OXIBAND® oxygen transducers and the DURAFORM™
oxygen transducer system are reusable sensors that are applied with disposable adhesive.
The DURASENSOR® DS-100A adult digit oxygen transducer is a reusable sensor with
its optical components mounted in a plastic casing. The NELLCOR® RS-10 reflectance
oxygen transducer is an adhesive sensor for application to forehead or temple.
NOTE: NELLCOR®, OXIBAND® and DURASENSOR® are registered trademarks
of NELLCOR® Incorporated. OXISENSOR™ and DURAFORM™ are trademarks of
NELLCOR Incorporated.
A. Selecting a Sensor
Sensors are designed for specific sites on patients with designated weight ranges. To select
the appropriate sensor, consider the patient’s weight, level of activity, adequacy of perfusion,
which sensor sites are available, whether sterility is required, and the anticipated duration of monitoring.
B. Cleaning and Re-Use
Do not immerse any OXISENSOR™, DURASENSOR®, OXIBAND®, or DURAFORM™
oxygen transducer, the NELLCOR® RS-10 oxygen transducer, or any NELLCOR®
adhesive in water or cleaning solution. Clean DURASENSOR®, OXIBAND®, and
DURAFORM™ oxygen transducers, and the NELLCOR® RS-10 oxygen transducer by
wiping with a disinfectant such as 70% alcohol. Do not sterilize by irradiation, steam, or
ethylene oxide. Use a new OXIBAND® adhesive wrap or FORM-A adhesive bandage for
each patient. Do not re-sterilize OXISENSOR™ oxygen transducers.
C. Performance Considerations
To insure optimal performance, use an appropriate sensor, apply it as directed, and
observe all warnings and cautions.
If excessive ambient light is present, cover the sensor site with opaque material. Failure to
do so may result in inaccurate measurements. Light sources that can affect performance include
surgical lights, especially those with a xenon light source, bilirubin lamps, fluorescent
lights, infrared heating lamps, and direct sunlight. If poor perfusion affects instrument
performance, and the patient weighs more than 50 kg (110 lbs.), consider using the
OXISENSOR™ R-15 adult nasal oxygen transducer. Because the R-15 obtains its
measurements from the nasal septal anterior ethmoid artery, an artery supplied by the
internal carotid, this sensor may obtain measurements when peripheral perfusion is
relatively poor. For low peripheral perfusion, consider using the NELLCOR® RS-10
reflectance oxygen transducer, which is applied to the forehead or temple.
1-38
Revised 02/15/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
If patient movement presents a problem:
· Verify that the sensor is properly and securely applied.
· Use a new sensor with fresh adhesive backing.
· Move the sensor to a less active site.
· Use a type of sensor that tolerates some patient motion, such as the OXISENSOR™
D-25, D-20, N-25, or I20 oxygen transducer.
NELLCOR® SENSOR FAMILY
SELECTION D25/D25L
R-15
GUIDE
Adult
Adult
>30 kg
>50 kg
Patient
Size
Duration Short or Long Short or
Term
Long Term
of Use
1
Sterile1
Sterility Sterile
Patient
Activity
1
N-25
Neonatal
<3 kg
>40 kg
Short or
Long Term
Sterile1
I-20
Infant
1-20 kg
D-20
Pediatric
10-50 kg
RS-10
Adult
>40 kg
Short or
Long Term
Sterile1
Short or
Long Term
Sterile1
Short Term
Nonsterile
Limited
Inactive
Limited
Limited
Limited
Limited
Activity
Activity
Activity
Activity
Activity
OXISENSOR OXISENSOR OXISENSOR OXISENSOR OXISENSOR RS-10
adult digit
adult nasal neonatal
infant digit pediatric
reflectance
oxygen
oxygen
oxygen
oxygen
digit oxygen oxygen
transducer
transducer transducer
transducer
transducer
transducer
In an unopened, undamaged package.
All NELLCOR® accessories and sensors must be purchased form NELLCOR® Inc.,
25495 Whitehall Street, Hayward, Ca. 94545. To contact NELLCOR®, call
1-800-NELLCOR.
D. Automatic Calibration of NELLCOR® Sensors
The oximetry subsystem incorporates automatic calibration mechanisms. It is
automatically calibrated each time it is turned on, at periodic intervals thereafter, and
whenever a new sensor is connected. Also, the intensity of the sensor’s LEDs is
adjusted automatically to compensate for differences in tissue thickness.
Each sensor is calibrated when manufactured; the effective mean wavelength of the red
LED is determined and encoded into a calibration resistor in the sensor plug. The
instrument’s software reads this calibration resistor to determine the appropriate
calibration coefficients for the measurements obtained by that sensor.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
Revised 02/15/00
1-39
1.3.10.3 Sequence for establishing SpO2 with Masimo Setâ Pulse Oximetry*
* This feature applicable only if available or installed on your unit.
1. Select the appropriate sensor for the patient from the table below. All sensors below are
non-sterile and can be used during patient movement.
MASIMO® SENSOR FAMILY
SELECTION
LNOP•Adt Adult
Disposable Finger Sensor

LNOP •Pdt Pediatric/
Slender Digit Disposable
Sensor

LNOP •Neo Neonatal
Disposable Sensor

LNOP •NeoPt Neonatal
Pre-term Disposable Sensor

LNOP •DCI Adult
Reusable Finger Sensor
PC12 Patient Cable
Extension
PART NUMBER
0600-00-0043-01
> 30 kg.
DISPOSABLE/
REUSABLE
Disposable
0600-00-0044-01
10 to 50 kg.
Disposable
0600-00-0045-01
< 10 kg.
Disposable
0600-00-0046-01
< 1 kg.
Disposable
0600-00-0047
> 30 kg.
Re-usable
All
Re-usable
0012-00-1099-02
PATIENT SIZE
2. Attach the PC12 Patient Cable (P/N 0012-00-1099-02) to the sensor and plug the other
end of the patient cable into the SpO2 connector (15)
NOTE: Do not place the sensor on an extremity with an invasive catheter or blood pressure
cuff in place.
NOTE: Ensure proper routing of patient cable to avoid entanglement and/or
strangulation.
1-40
CAUTION:
When equipped with MASIMO® SpO2, use only MASIMO® oxygen transducers
including MASIMO LNOP® patient dedicated adhesive sensors and MASIMO
PC12® Patient Cable. Use of other oxygen transducers may cause improper oximeter
performance.
CAUTION:
Tissue damage or inaccurate measurements may be caused by incorrect sensor
application or use, such as wrapping it too tightly, applying supplemental tape,
failing to inspect the sensor site periodically, or failing to position it appropriately.
Carefully read the sensor directions for use, the Accutorr Plus operating instructions,
and all precautionary information before use.
CAUTION:
Excessive ambient light may cause inaccurate measurements. Cover the sensor site
with opaque material.
CAUTION:
Inaccurate measurements may be caused by incorrect sensor application or use;
significant levels of dysfunctional hemoglobins, (e.g., carboxyhemoglobin or
methemoglobin); or intra-vascular dyes such as indocyanine green methylene blue;
exposure to excessive illumination, such as surgical lamps (especially ones with a
xenon light source), bilirubin lamps, fluorescent lights, infrared heating lamps, or
direct sunlight; excessive patient movement; venous pulsations; electro-surgical
Revised 06/19/01
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
interference; and placement of a sensor on an extremity that has a blood pressure
cuff, arterial catheter, or intra-vascular line.
CAUTION:
In certain situations in which perfusion and signal strength are low, such as in
patients with thick or pigmented skin, inaccurately low SpO2 readings will
result. Verification of oxygenation should be made, especially in preterm infants
and patients with chronic lung disease, before instituting any therapy or
intervention.
CAUTION:
Many patients suffer from poor peripheral perfusion due to hypothermia,
hypovolemia, severe vasoconstriction, reduced cardiac output, etc. These symptoms
may cause a loss in vital sign readings.
CAUTION:
The site should be checked at least every eight (8) hours (every four (4) hours
with the Adult re-usable finger sensor). Ensure proper adhesion, skin integrity,
and proper alignment. Nail polish and fungus may effect readings. Exercise
extreme caution with poorly perfused patients. Skin erosion and pressure necrosis
can be caused when sensors are not frequently monitored. Assess the site every two
(2) hours with poorly perfused patients.
CAUTION:
If the sensor or patient cable is damaged in any way, discontinue use
immediately. To prevent damage do not soak or immerse the sensor in any liquid
solution. Do not attempt to sterilize.
3. The digital SpO2 value and SpO2 Pulse Rate will be displayed on the SpO2 and Pulse
Rate LED’s.
4. If desired, adjust the beep volume. See Section 3.7, “Setting the Alarm Volume and
Beep Volume”, for details on adjusting the beep volume.
1.3.10.3.1 MASIMO® Sensors and Patient Cable
MASIMO® provides a family of sensors suitable for a wide variety of clinical settings and
patients. Specific sensors have been developed for neonates, infants, children, and adults.
All sensors are indicated for continuous non invasive monitoring of arterial oxygen
saturation (SpO2) and pulse rate. The LNOP•DCI Adult Re-usable Finger Sensor can
also be used for “spot check” applications if needed. All sensors are intended for
“single-patient use only” except for the LNOP•DCI Adult “Re-usable” Finger Sensor.
A. Selecting a Sensor
Sensors are designed for specific sites on patients with designated weight ranges. To select
the appropriate sensor, consider the patient’s weight, level of activity, adequacy of perfusion,
which sensor sites are available and the anticipated duration of monitoring.
B. Cleaning and Re-use
The sensor may be reattached to the same patient if the emitter and detector windows are
clear and the adhesive still adheres to the skin. The adhesive can be partially rejuvenated
by wiping with an alcohol wipe and allowing the sensor to thoroughly air dry prior to
replacement on the patient.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
Revised 06/19/01
1-41
C. Performance Considerations
To insure optimal performance, use an appropriate sensor, apply it as directed, and observe
all warnings and cautions.
If excessive ambient light is present, cover the sensor site with opaque material. Failure
to do so may result in inaccurate measurements. Light sources that can affect performance
include surgical lights, especially those with a xenon light source, bilirubin lamps,
fluorescent lights, infrared heating lamps, and direct sunlight.
Special Features
D. Automatic Calibration
The oximetry subsystem incorporates automatic calibration mechanisms. It is
automatically calibrated each time it is turned on, at periodic intervals thereafter, and
whenever a new sensor is connected. Also, the intensity of the sensor’s LEDs is adjusted
automatically to compensate for differences in tissue thickness.
Each sensor is calibrated when manufactured; the effective mean wavelength of the red
LED is determined and encoded into a calibration resistor in the sensor plug. The
instrument’s software reads this calibration resistor to determine the appropriate
calibration coefficients for the measurements obtained by that sensor.
E. Oximetry Sensitivity Mode and Post Averaging Time
The Accutorr Plus sensitivity mode for SpO2 is set to normal and the averaging of the
saturation, pulse rate, and signal strength measurements for SpO2 is set to 8 seconds
1-42
Added 02/15/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
1.3.12
RECORDER (optional)
The Accutorr Plus can provide a permanent record of patient data using the PRINT key
(12). There are two print modes available. They are Continuous Print or Request Print.
In the Continuous Print mode the printer will print each time there is a valid NIBP or
Temperature measurement. In the Request Print mode the printer will print all of the
stored information for the displayed patient.
1. Attach the Recorder Module as shown in section 1.3.17.
2. Press the PRINT key (12) (1 beep tone) to generate a Request printing. The recorder
will print all stored measurements for the currently displayed patient. Press the
PRINT key (1 beep tone) while a printing is in progress, to stop the printing.
3. Press and hold the PRINT key (12) (2 beep tones, approx. 3 seconds) to switch the
print mode between Continuous and Request. When in the Continuous mode the
Print LED (13) is illuminated.
NOTE: When a printing is in progress and the PRINT key is pressed or Room Number
and/or Bed Letter is changed, the printing will stop.
M/D/Y 11/25/97 02a
HH:MM SYS DIA MAP
15:25[122][ 88][ 99]
BPM SPO2
EF/C
[S 64][ 99] P 98.9
HH:MM SYS DIA MAP
15:20 120 [ 88] 99
EF/C
BPM SPO2
S 64
99 P 98.9
HH:MM SYS DIA MAP
15:15 120
88
99
EF/C
BPM SPO2
S 64
99
---HH:MM SYS DIA MAP
15:10 120 [ 88] 99
BPM SPO2
EF/C
[S 64] 99 P 98.9
HH:MM SYS DIA MAP
15:05 [120] 88
99
EF/C
BPM SPO2
S 64
99 P 98.9
The Date and Room/Bed is printed for
each group of measurements.
Parameter Headings are repeated for each
line of measurements.
Brackets are printed around measurements
that caused an alarm violation.
P or I is printed with the Temp measurement,
indicating the temperature was acquired from a
Predictive or the AccuTemp IR thermometer.
When no information is available for a particular
parameter, dashes are printed.
S or N is printed with the Pulse Rate (BPM)
measurement, indicating the Pulse Rate was
acquired from SpO2 or NIBP.
Figure 1-18 Recorder Strip Sample
When the Predictive thermometer is used, “P” is printed next to the temperature measurement. When
the IR thermometer is used, “I” is printed next to the temperature measurement. When NIBP is used
to obtain a pulse rate measurement, “N” is printed next to the pulse rate measurement. When SpO2
is used to obtain a pulse rate measurement, “S” is printed next to the pulse rate measurement. If data
is not available for any given parameter, “—-” is printed under that parameter. Parameter values
that violated alarm limits are indicated by the brackets “[ ]”.
1-46
Revised 02/15/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
1.3.13
HOW TO SET THE CLOCK (Date and Time)
The clock can be set during normal operation or in the User Configuration. See section
1.3.15, for details on entering the User Configuration. The Timer/Temp key (32),
Interval/Elap. Time/Temp Display (33), and the Up and Down arrow keys (27 & 28) are
used to set the time and date. PRECAUTION: Changing any part of the time or date
will cause all stored patient information (trend data) to be permanently erased. Viewing
the time or date does NOT cause data to be erased.
1. Press and hold the Timer/Temp key (32)
(2 beep tones, approx. 6 seconds). The hour
digit only displays.
2. Press the Patient Info. Up or Down Arrow
key (27 or 28) to change the number.
NOTE: The Accutorr Plus always displays
time in a 24 hour format.
Hour
Display
TIMER/TEMP
INTERVAL ELAP
. TIME TEMP
ALARMS
MUTE
5. After the year has been selected, the next
press of the Timer/Temp key (32) exits the
clock set mode and enters the new
information.
Press and hold
to enter the clock
set mode. Set hour,
then press again to
set the minute.
Press to Change
3. Press the Timer/Temp key (32) to activate
the minute display.
4. Press the Patient Info. Up or Down Arrow
key (27 or 28) to change the number.
Continue pressing the Timer/Temp key
and the Arrow keys to set the month, day,
and year (in that order).
SET
ALARMS
Figure 1-19 - Setting the Hour
Minute
Display
TIMER/TEMP
INTERVAL ELAP
. TIME TEMP
ALARMS
MUTE
SET
ALARMS
After the time
and date have
been set, press
to exit the clock
set mode.
Press to Change
Figure 1-20 - Setting the Minute
To cancel a changed value while that value
is still displayed, press the DEFAULTS
key (14) for less than 3 seconds.
If the TIMER/TEMP or Arrow keys have not
been pressed for 15 seconds, the Accutorr
Plus returns to normal operation and saves
any Time/Date changes.
When the clock is displayed, it displays real-time
(current time). When the clock is displayed while
viewing previous data, frozen time is displayed.
When frozen time is displayed, the colon
between the hours and minutes is illuminated
continuously. When real-time is displayed the
colon between the hours and minutes flashes.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
Revised 02/15/00
1-47
1.3.14
BATTERY OPERATION
When the Accutorr Plus is powered from the battery, the Battery Indicator (17) is
illuminated continuously.
To conserve power, most displays will blank (time out) at user selected times. The LCD
illumination time out can be set between 3 and 15 minutes. The LED displays time out
can be set between 5 and 60 minutes. Since the Accutorr Plus can be powered from either
an AC or DC source, the user configuration allows the setting of separate times for each
type of power source. See User Configuration, section 3.15 for more information on
setting the time out minutes.
When the battery charge is low, but not below the cutoff voltage, the battery LED will
flash and the recorder will not operate. When the LED begins to flash on Sealed lead acid
units, approximately 30 minutes of battery time remain for the Accutorr Plus NIBP, 20
minutes for the Accutorr Plus NIBP with Trend Screen and 10 minutes for the Accutorr
Plus NIBP with Trend Screen and SpO2. Units with Lithium ion batteries will provide
approximately 10 minutes of low battery warning time.
When the battery charge drops below the cutoff voltage the Accutorr Plus will
automatically turn off. Patient information will be retained for later use.
Battery run time for the Accutorr Plus NIBP is approximately 5 hours with a Sealed lead
acid battery or 8 hours with a Lithium ion battery using a new fully charged battery at
25EC with a NIBP measurement taken every 5 minutes and the recorder not in use.
Battery run time for the Accutorr Plus NIBP with Trend Screen is approximately 3 hours
for a Sealed lead acid battery or 8 hours for a Lithium ion battery using a new fully
charged battery at 25EC with a NIBP measurement taken every 5 minutes and the
recorder not in use. Battery run time for the Accutorr Plus NIBP with Trend Screen and
Datascope SpO2 is approximately 1.5 hours for a Sealed lead acid battery or 3.5 hours for a
Lithium ion battery using a new fully charged battery at 25EC with a NIBP measurement
taken every 5 minutes continuous SpO2 measurement and the recorder not in use. Battery
run time for the Accutorr Plus NIBP with Trend Screen and Masimo or Nellcor SpO2 is
approximately 2 hours for a Sealed lead acid battery or 4.5 hours for a Lithium ion battery
using a new fully charged battery at 25EC with a NIBP measurement taken every 5 minutes
continuous SpO2 measurement and the recorder not in use.
The Accutorr Plus automatically recharges the battery, when required, when the unit is
plugged into an AC receptacle. Maximum battery recharge time is 8 hours for Sealed
lead acid or 2 hours for Lithium ion.
CAUTION: To avoid loss of patient data (trend), do not replace the battery unless the
Accutorr Plus is connected to an AC receptacle. Hospital defaults and the time are
unaffected by battery replacement.
1-48
Revised 12/20/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
1.3.15
USER CONFIGURATION
The User Configuration Mode allows the operator the opportunity to set custom default
settings. These custom default settings will be used each time the Accutorr Plus is
turned on. Once the User Configuration Mode is entered, the only way to exit this mode
is to turn off the Accutorr Plus using the ON/STANDBY key (19).
1. To enter the User Configuration Mode, press and hold the DEFAULTS key (14) while
turning the unit ON. Release after the third beep.
2. To select a User Configuration item number, press the ROOM/BED key (24) to
display the desired User Configuration Number in the ROOM and BED displays
(25 & 26). See table below for User Configuration Numbers. The current default
setting for that item displays.
3. Press the NIBP START key (38) to be able to change the default value. The default
setting flashes.
4. Press the Patient Info. Up or Down Arrow key (27 or 28) to change the default setting.
5. Press the START NIBP key (38) to enter the changed default setting.
6. Repeat step 2 for additional choices.
The following table list the functions that can be configured in the user configuration mode.
User
Configuration
Number
Function
Description
1a
Clock Set
1b
Date Format
2
Setting the date and time. See
section 1.3.13 for details on setting
the clock.
Set the format as M/D/Y (1231)* D/M/Y (3112)*
or D/M/Y (3112)*
Reserved for future
use.
Text / Symbols
Set the description of which alarm
limit is being set, Hi and Lo or the
graphic
. Also change the
Interval of OFF to ——.
Patient Size
Set the default patient size to be
Adult, Pediatric and Neonate.
Time Out, LEDs Set how long the numeric
and LCD Characters information is displayed, when no
when unit is
keys have been pressed, in the
powered from AC LEDs and LCD before they are
mains.
blanked to conserve energy. The
choices are: 5, 15, 30 or 60
minutes. NOTE: The information
is not erased.
Time Out, LEDs Set how long the numeric information is displayed, when no keys
and LCD
have been pressed, in the LEDs
Characters when
and LCD before they are blanked
unit is powered
from the internal to conserve energy. The choices
are: 5, 15, 20 or 30 minutes.
battery.
NOTE: The information is not
erased.
3
4
5a
5b
Factory Default
The word “Hi” which will
then use Hi and Lo as
the indicators. OFF for
Interval.
Adult
15 minutes
5 minutes
*1231 represents 12 months/31 days and 3112 represents 31 days/12 months.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
Revised 02/15/00
1-49
User
Configuration
Number
Function
Description
5c
Time Out, Light
in the LCD when
the unit is powered
from AC mains.
Time Out, Light
in the LCD when
the unit is
powered from the
internal battery.
Adult Initial
Inflation Pressure
Set how long the light will stay
3 minutes
on, when no keys are pressed, in
the LCD. The choices are: 3, 5, 10
or 15 minutes.
Set how long the light will stay
3 minutes
on, when no keys are pressed, in
the LCD. The choices are: 3, 5, 10
or 15 minutes.
5d
6a
6b
6c
7
8
9a
9b
9c
10a
10b
11
12
1-50
Revised 02/15/00
Factory Default
Set the initial cuff inflation pressure
for an adult size patient. The
choices are: 100 to 260 mmHg at
5 mmHg increments.
Pediatric Initial
Set the initial cuff inflation pressure
Inflation Pressure for a pediatric size patient. The
choices are: 60 to 180 mmHg at 5
mmHg increments.
Neonate Initial
See the initial cuff inflation
Inflation Pressure pressure for a neonate size patient.
The choices are: 40 to 120 mmHg
at 5 mmHg increments.
Adaptive Inflation Choices are ON or OFF. If User
Configuration #3 is set to display
graphics, the choices are -l- or -O-.
Interval Setting
Set the NIBP Interval Time. The
choices are: OFF (or ——), Cont.
(Continuous), 1, 2.5, 5, 10, 15,
20, 30, 60, 120, and 240 minutes.
Adult Alarm
Set the default alarm limit values for
Limits
an Adult size patient. See Section 1.3.5
for details on setting alarm limits.
Pediatric Alarm
Set the default alarm limit values
Limits
for a Pediatric size patient. See
Section 1.3.5 for details on setting
alarm limits.
Neonate Alarm
See the default alarm limit values
Limits
for an Neonate size patient. See
Section 1.3.5 for details on setting
alarm limits.
Alarm Volume
Set the volume of an alarm signal.
The choices are: 1, 2, 3, 4 & 5. 5 is
the loudest.
SpO2 Volume
Set the volume of the SpO2 beep.
The choices are: Off (or ——), 1,
2, 3, 4 & 5. 5 is the loudest.
Continuous Print Choices are ON or OFF. If User
Configuration #3 is set to display
graphics, the choices are -l- or -O-.
Reset to Factory
To change all of the User
Defaults
Configuration items back to the
Factory Defaults, while in User
Config. #12, press and hold the
START NIBP key for 3 seconds.
180 mmHg
140 mmHg
100 mmHg
ON
OFF (or ——)
OFF, except SpO2 low
which is 86
OFF, except SpO2 low
which is 86
OFF, except SpO2 low
which is 86
4
OFF
OFF
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
1.3.16
STATUS AND ERROR CODES
The Accutorr Plus uses the various displays on the front panel to display the operational
status. Status and error codes listed below can generally be resolved by the user however,
some error codes, which are marked with an asterisk (*), may require resolution by a
qualified technical service person. These codes with their descriptions are listed on the
back of the Quick Reference card. NOTE: Status codes 8810 through 8858 can be
cleared from the Room and Bed displays by pressing the Room/Bed key (24).
Status and Error Code Table
TYPE
NIBP
TEMP
(PTM)
SpO2
CODE DESCRIPTION
8810 Retry - Unable to
Measure
8811 Retry - Pump
Higher
8812 Stop - Cuff
Overpressure
8813 Stop - Unable to
Measure
8830 Check Probe
8831 Replace Probe
8832 Battery Low
8850 No Sensor
8851 Sensor Off
8852
8853
8854
8855
8856
8857
8857
8857
8858
8858
8858
SYSTEM 984*
985*
986*
987*
988*
990*
991*
995*
996*
REASON
Motion artifact, cycle time-out, weak pulsations or no pulsations. A triple beep tone is generated.
Insufficient cuff pressure. A triple beep tone is generated.
Excessive cuff pressure detected by the software. A triple beep
tone is generated.
4 successive measurement attempts failed. A triple beep tone is
generated.
Tissue contact may have been lost.
Defective probe or connection.
The 9V battery needs replacement.
No sensor connected.
Sensor not on patient.
(Datascope and Masimo SpO2 only)
Interference
Interference on signal.
(Datascope and Masimo SpO2 only)
Pulse Search
Unit cannot find signal. (Nellcor SpO2 Module will report
“Pulse Search” -8853- when the sensor is not on the patient.)
Weak Pulse
Weak pulse detected.
(Datascope and Masimo SpO2 only)
No Pulse
No pulse detected. (Datascope SpO2 only)
Check Sensor
Sensor problem.
(Datascope and Masimo SpO2 only)
PR<30
Pulse rate is less than 30 bpm. (Datascope SpO2 only)
PR<21
Pulse rate is less than 21 bpm. (Nellcor SpO2 only)
PR<26
Pulse rate is less than 26 bpm. (Masimo SpO2 only)
PR>249
Pulse rate is greater than 249 bpm. (Nellcor SpO2 only)
PR>239
Pulse rate is greater than 239 bpm. (Masimo SpO2 only)
PR>250
Pulse rate is greater than 250 bpm. (Datascope SpO2 only)
NIBP Hardware Failure NIBP A/D failure detected.
NIBP Overpressure
The overpressure circuit is not set to the current patient size.
Circuit not
Programmed
NIBP Overpressure
The two pressure transducers are not tracking each other.
Circuit not Tracking
Stop - Hardware
Excessive cuff pressure detected by hardware over-pressure sensor. A triple beep tone is generated.
Overpressure
TEMP Bad Calibration Thermometer needs calibration.
TEMP Illegal Mode
Thermometer switch is set wrong.
TEMP Module Failed Thermometer internal failure.
SpO2 Uncalibrated
SpO2 fails calibration check.
SpO2 Failure
SpO2 failed self-test.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
Revised 02/15/00
1-51
1.3.17
HOW TO ATTACH OPTIONAL THERMOMETER and
RECORDER MODULES
The Accutorr Plus can be configured with a Recorder Module and Thermometer Module.
To Attach the Recorder Module:
Looking at the rear panel of the unit, the Recorder Module is attached to the right side of
the Accutorr Plus.
1. Insure that the Accutorr Plus is OFF.
2. Insert the tab on the Recorder Module into the Recorder Module Connector (48) on
the Accutorr Plus. Push firmly to seat properly.
3. Use the 2 screws provided to secure the Recorder Module to the Accutorr Plus.
To Attach the Thermometer Module:
Looking at the rear panel of the unit, the Thermometer Module is attached to the left
side of the Accutorr Plus.
1. Insure that the Accutorr Plus is OFF.
2. Insert the tab on the Thermometer Module into the Thermometer Module Connector
(42) on the Accutorr Plus. Push firmly to seat properly.
3. Use the 2 screws provided to secure the Thermometer Module to the Accutorr Plus.
AccuTemp
Thermometer
Module
Screw
--OR--
Tab
Recorder
Module
Tab
Accutorr Plus with
Trend Screen and SpO2
Screw
Predictive
Thermometer
Module
Figure 1-21 Attaching Optional Modules
1-52
Revised 02/15/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
1.3.18
PLACEMENT OF THE QUICK REFERENCE CARD
The Quick Reference card provides abbreviated descriptions of front panel keys on one
side, and on the other side provides descriptions of the status codes. To attach the Quick
Reference card, thread the NIBP hose through the two holes in the card.
NIBP
PATIENT
SETUP
START
N I BP
DEFLATE
V
INTERVAL
Choose Patient Size
Start NIBP
Measurement
Stop NIBP Measurement
Deflate Cuff
Set Interval
TIMER/TEMP
.
Interval, Elapsed Time or Temperature
ALARMS
SET
ALARMS
MUTE
Choose a Parameter,
use arrows to change
Silence Alarm
PATIENT INFO.
Up/
Increase
Down/
Decrease
ROOM
BED
Activates Room /Bed
mode, use arrows to change
DATA
SCAN
Display Prior Measurement(s)
DELETE
INFO
To erase most recent measurement,
press DATA SCAN, then press and
hold DELETE INFO for 1 beep
ACCUTORR ® PLUS WITH TREND
Thread the NIBP
hose through the
2 holes in the Quick
Reference Card.
MENU
Switch Trend/Menu Display
SELECT
Select Parameter
PRINT
Press to print/stop print
DEFAULTS
Press and hold for 2 beeps to
restore all hospital settings
Figure 1-22 Placement of Quick Reference Label
NOTE: The card shown in figure 1-22 is a sample to show how to attach the card. The
actual card may differ.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
Revised 02/15/00
1-53
1.3.19
PLACEMENT OF RECORDER PAPER LOADING LABEL
The Recorder Paper Loading label is designed to be placed on the recorder module.
Attach label as shown in the figure below.
PRINT
Drucken
Imprimer
Stampa
Imprimir
2X
Figure 1-23 Placement of Recorder Paper Loading Label
1-54
Revised 02/15/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 1, Operation
2.0 THEORY OF OPERATION
CONTENTS OF THIS CHAPTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Page
2.1 Block Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1
2.2 Detailed Circuit Description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2
The Theory of Operation provides block diagrams of major operational circuits, an
overview of each circuit board and functional descriptions of the major sections on that
board. The information presented is intended to assist qualified service personnel to
isolate faults to the lowest functional sub assembly and replacement of the same.
2.1 BLOCK DIAGRAMS
The system level block diagram illustrates the major functional modules and their
interdependence. More detailed diagrams for particular functional modules are provided
within the Theory of Operation.
Block Diagrams
Page
Interconnect Diagrams
LED/CPU Board Block Diagram
NIBP Block Diagram
Recorder Module Control Logic Block Diagram
Predicative Temperature Module Block Diagram
Datascope SpO2 Block Diagram
Communication Board Block Diagram
LCD inverter Module Block Diagram
Nellcor® MP304 Block Diagram
NellcorÒ Interface Board Block Diagram
MasimoÒ Interface Board Block Diagram
Tone Processor Board Block Diagram
2-3
2-9
2-19
2-20
2-21
2-24
2-27
2-28
2-29
2-30
2-32
2-34
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 2 - Theory of Operation
Revised 12/20/00
2-1
2.2 DETAILED CIRCUIT DESCRIPTIONS
This section of the manual describes the operation of each circuit block. Refer to the
schematic diagrams in Chapter 5.
Included are descriptions for the following Circuit Board Assemblies:
Circuit Descriptions
2.2.1 LCD/CPU Module
2.2.2 NIBP Module, Linear Bleed
2.2.3 Recorder Module
2.2.4 Predictive Thermometer Module
2.2.5 SpO2 Module
2.2.6 Main Power Supply
2.2.7 Communication Board
2.2.8 LCD Inverter Module
2.2.9 Nellcor® MP304 Board
2.2.10 Nellcor® Interface Board
2.2.11 Masimo SetÒ Technology
2.2.12 MasimoÒ Interface Board Theory of Operation
2.2.13 Tone Processor Board Theory of Operation
2-2
Revised 12/20/00
Page
2-9
2-17
2-20
2-21
2-22
2-25
2-26
2-28
2-29
2-30
2-31
2-32
2-34
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 2 - Theory of Operation
-
+
J2
1 2 3 4 5
Batt. Fuse
4A/250
+
5x20mm
-
J3
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
+5 V
+5 V
D Gnd
D Gnd
+15
-15
A Gnd
Pwr Gnd
+12
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
J3
Stdby
AC On
+12-15 On
Off / On
Charger Off
1
2
3
4
J2
3 2 1
100 VAC
LCD Inverter
0014-00-0180
J4
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
3 2 1
0670-00-0649
J2
J1
1 2 34
+ 5 vdc
Speaker in
Speaker Rtn
Dump*
L Ven*
B Fast*
S Gain*
Pump
Ped
Neo
Overpr. Det*
Clear*
Gain 0
Gain 1
+15 V
Charger Off*
A Gnd
Off / On*
-15 V
AC Connected*
+12, -15 On*
VBULK, 9 to 17 VDC
EOC
EL Lite Off*
n/c
Ser. Data Out
Ser. Data In
Ser. Clock
AD Clear Send*
+5 V
+5 V Recorder
+5 V
+5 V Recorder
D Gnd
P Gnd
D Gnd
D Gnd
J6
1
2
3
J1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
CPU / LED Board
0670-00-0650-03 for units with SpO2
0670-00-0650-04 for units Without SpO2
J8
J7
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
J2
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
J3
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
D. Gnd
Temp-TXD
NC
Temp-RXD
NC
NC
+5 V
D. Gnd
Pred. Temp.
Infrared Temp
+15 In
J4
Analog Ground
-15 In
+5 In
TXD
Digital Ground
RXD
Digital Ground
HRST
Digital Ground
Display Bus, D0
Display Bus, D1
Display Bus, D2
Display Bus, D3
Display Bus, D4
Display Bus, D5
Display Bus, D6
Display Bus, D7
WR_LED3*
ACON LED
ACON
KEY 2
KEY 1
KEY 0
KEY D7
KEY D6
KEY D5
KEY D4
KEY D3
KEY D2
KEY D1
KEY D0
ON / OFF SW*
D Gnd
Address Bus, A2
No Connection
No Connection
Hi_Low*
LCD_Unit
+5 V
Ext_RXD
Ext_RTS
Ext_TXD
Ext_CTS
D Gnd
D Gnd
+5 V
RD
TD
CTS
RTS
CSTAT*
9 to 17 VDC Bulk
D Gnd
Nurse Call
P1
P1
part of IR cradle assembly
1
J2
2
Thermometer,
Security
Infrared Magnet
Interface Board
0670-00-0585
Receiving photocell
+12 VDC
Ext_RXD
Ext_RTS
Ext_TXD
Ext_CTS
Nurse Call
D Gnd
Ext_RXD
D Gnd
Ext_TXD
Grd
P1
+5 Therm
1
3
4
5
6
7
8,9
Temp. Probe receptacle
0012-00-0953 WITH 9V battery or
0012-00-1335 WITHOUT 9V battery
Batt. in
handpiece
Thermometer,
Infrared hand
held device.
Transmit LED
J3
IR Drive
LED Common
Red Drive
Probe ID Ret.
Probe ID
Det. Shield
Det. Anode
Det. Cathode
NC
NC
Three circuit phone jack
Datascope
Ring
Communication
Sleeve
Tip
Connector
9 pin female DIN
External
Interface Conn.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
+
9 V Alkaline Batt.
Thermometer, J3
Batt. Grd
Predictive,
1
circuit board
Therm. Rtn
0670-00-0582 2
Batt. in main housing
+
9 V Alkaline Batt.
Battery shown but not
used in all versions
0997-00-0426
J1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
_
0146-00-0069
+
_
J5 P1
19,20 15,16 11,12 7,8 5,6 3,4 1,2
17,18 13,14 9,10
Accutorr Plus with Datascope
SpO2 and without SpO2
Block Diagram
Revised 12/20/00
2-3
SpO2 Sensor receptical
-
J6
J5
Chassis Gnd
D Gnd
+5 V
View Angle Control
WR_LCD*
RD_LCD*
CS_LCD*
A<1>
D Gnd
Reset*
Bus, <0>
Bus, <1>
Bus, <2>
Bus, <3>
Bus, <4>
Bus, <5>
Bus, <6>
Bus, <7>
D Gnd
+5 V
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
0330-00-0025-XX
19,20 15,16 11,12 7,8 5,6 3,41,2
17,18 13,14 9,10
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
Units without Trend display,
and No SpO2: 0331-00-0104
19,20 15,16 11,12 7,8 5,6 3,41,2
17,18 13,14 9,10
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
DGnd
WR Recd
DGnd
RESET
HOME
RUN
DREQ
+5V
+5VP
PGND
+5VP
PGND
0330-00-0027-XX
Reed Sw.
Units with Trend display, and
SpO2: 0331-00-0103
Thermister
1 2 34
1 2 3
CAPTIVE CABLE
AC Hot
Filter Board
0670-00-0584-03
P Gnd
+12 V
0670-00-0593-03
0330-00-0026-XX
Tone Processor Board Tone Processor Board
shown but not used in
0670-00-1134
all versions
0160-00-0034
GRAPHIC OVERLAYS:
Speaker
NIBP Board
0670-00-0584-02
LCD lite Off
100 VAC
return
LCD Display
Module
0146-00-0043
AC Neut
N/C
12 Volt
NIBP Pump
+12 V
Datascope
SpO2 Circuit
Board
Units with Trend display, and
No SpO2: 0331-00-0102
J7
Rtn. Switched
2. Functional blocks with dashed outlines are optional
features. (---)
3. Shaded blocks are considered
"black box" devices
KEYPADS:
External Communication
Circuit board
0670-00-0661-01
Recorder
circuit board
0670-00-0583
100 VAC
CAPTIVE CABLE
Electro luminescent
panel lite
12 V Battery
Lead Acid
AC Gnd
+12 V Filt
P Gnd
Pump Rtn
+12 V Nfilt
J4
3 2
J4
1 2 3 OR
+
DC Power Supply
0014-00-0184 (SLA)
OR
0014-00-0225 (Li-Ion)
Notes:
1. Detailed functional descriptions
are found in the Theory of Operations section
10.8 V Battery
Lithium - Ion
Accutorr Plus with Datascope SpO2 or without SpO2
Interconnect Diagram
OR
-
+
J2
1 2 3 4 5
Batt. Fuse
4A/250
+
5x20mm
-
J3
J3
J4
+5 vdc
Speaker in
Speaker Rtn
Dump*
L Ven*
B Fast*
S Gain*
Pump
Ped
Neo
Overpr. Det*
Clear*
Gain 0
Gain 1
+15 V
Charger Off*
A Gnd
Off / On*
-15 V
AC Connected*
+12, -15 On*
VBULK, 9 to 17 VDC
EOC
EL Lite Off*
n/c
Ser. Data Out
Ser. Data In
Ser. Clock
AD Clear Send*
+5 V
+5 V Recorder
+5 V
+5 V Recorder
D Gnd
P Gnd
D Gnd
D Gnd
J6
1
2
3
J1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
J7
6,8,10
J2
D. Gnd
Temp-TXD
NC
Temp-RXD
NC
NC
+5 V
D. Gnd
Pred. Temp.
Infrared Temp
+5
SpO2-TX
SpO2-RX
SpO2RST*
SpO2 gnd
J4
J1
6,8,10
P1
P1
9 V Alkaline Batt.
+
Batt. in main housing
1
J2
2
Grd
+5 Therm
1
3
4
5
6
7
8,9
P1
Transmit LED
Batt. in
handpiece
Three circuit phone jack
Datascope
Ring
Communication
Sleeve
Tip
Connector
9 pin female DIN
External
Interface Conn.
Dect. Cath.
Detector
LED +
Inner shield
LED -
Out. shield
Rcal
Rcal Rtn.
Thermometer,
Infrared hand
held device.
+
9 V Alkaline Batt.
Thermometer, J3
Batt. Grd
Predictive,
1
circuit board
Therm. Rtn
0670-00-0582 2
Thermometer,
Security
Infrared Magnet
Interface Board
0670-00-0585
part of IR cradle assembly
Receiving photocell
0997-00-0426
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
+12 VDC
Ext_RXD
Ext_RTS
Ext_TXD
Ext_CTS
Nurse Call
D Gnd
Ext_RXD
D Gnd
Ext_TXD
7 14 6 1 8 2 9 13
NELLCOR SpO2
Sensor Receptacle
+5 V
+5 V
D Gnd
D Gnd
+15
-15
A Gnd
Pwr Gnd
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
Display Bus, D0
Display Bus, D1
Display Bus, D2
Display Bus, D3
Display Bus, D4
Display Bus, D5
Display Bus, D6
Display Bus, D7
WR_LED3*
ACON LED
ACON
KEY 2
KEY 1
KEY 0
KEY D7
KEY D6
KEY D5
KEY D4
KEY D3
KEY D2
KEY D1
KEY D0
ON / OFF SW*
D Gnd
Address Bus, A2
No Connection
No Connection
Hi_Low*
LCD_Unit
+5 V
Ext_RXD
Ext_RTS
Ext_TXD
Ext_CTS
D Gnd
D Gnd
+5 V
RD
TD
CTS
RTS
CSTAT*
9 to 17 VDC Bulk
D Gnd
Nurse Call
Temp. Probe receptacle
0012-00-0953 WITH 9V battery or
0012-00-1335 WITHOUT 9V battery
5 3
4
2
1
6
8
+12
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
3 2 1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
J3
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
Accutorr Plus with NELLCOR
SpO2 and without SpO2
Block Diagram
Revised 12/20/00
2-4
All other pins N/C
_
0671-00-0162
J3
-
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
Stdby
AC On
+12-15 On
Off / On
Charger Off
1
2
3
4
J2
100 VAC
LCD Inverter
0014-00-0180
3 2 1
0670-00-0649
J2
J1
1 2 34
J8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
0330-00-0025-XX
7
_
J5 P1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
Units without Trend display,
and No SpO2: 0331-00-0104
Reed Sw.
0330-00-0027-XX
19,20 15,16 11,12 7,8 5,6 3,41,2
17,18 13,14 9,10
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
DGnd
WR Recd
DGnd
RESET
HOME
RUN
DREQ
+5V
+5VP
PGND
+5VP
PGND
0330-00-0026-XX
19,20 15,16 11,12 7,8 5,6 3,41,2
17,18 13,14 9,10
19,20 15,16 11,12 7,8 5,6 3,4 1,2
17,18 13,14 9,10
4
5
7
9
0146-00-0069
+
Battery shown but
used in all versions
grnds
2,3,5, Male / Fem. Header
12,14
4 7 8 9 10 13
Units with Trend display, and
No SpO2: 0331-00-0102
Thermister
1 2 34
J6
J5
CAPTIVE CABLE
GRAPHIC OVERLAYS:
KEYPADS:
P Gnd
+12 V
9 7 5 4
Tone Processor Board Tone Processor Board
shown but not used in
0670-00-1134
all versions
0160-00-0034
1 2 3
Chassis Gnd
D Gnd
+5 V
View Angle Control
WR_LCD*
RD_LCD*
CS_LCD*
A<1>
D Gnd
Reset*
Bus, <0>
Bus, <1>
Bus, <2>
Bus, <3>
Bus, <4>
Bus, <5>
Bus, <6>
Bus, <7>
D Gnd
+5 V
CPU / LED Board
0670-00-0650-03 for units with SpO2
0670-00-0650-04 for units Without SpO2
Speaker
NIBP Board
0670-00-0584-02
LCD lite Off
100 VAC
return
LCD Display
Module
AC Hot
Filter Board
0670-00-0584-03
100 VAC
0146-00-0043
AC Neut
N/C
12 Volt
NIBP Pump
+12 V
NELLCOR
SpO2 Circuit
Board MP304
Units with Trend display, and
NELLCOR SpO2: 0331-00-0108
J7
Rtn. Switched
2. Functional blocks with dashed outlines are optional
features. (---)
3. Shaded blocks are considered
"black box" devices
NELLCOR SpO2
interface board
0670-00-0675
External Communication
Circuit board
0670-00-0661-01
Recorder
circuit board
0670-00-0583
CAPTIVE CABLE
Electro luminescent
panel lite
12 V Battery
Lead Acid
J4
AC Gnd
+12 V Filt
P Gnd
Pump Rtn
+12 V Nfilt
J4
3 2
1 2 3 OR
+
DC Power Supply
0014-00-0184 (SLA)
OR
0014-00-0225 (Li-Ion)
Notes:
1. Detailed functional descriptions
are found in the Theory of Operations section
10.8 V Battery
Lithium - Ion
Accutorr Plus with NELLCOR SpO2 or without SpO2
Interconnect Diagram
OR
-
+
1 2 3 4 5
J3
J3
J4
+5 vdc
Speaker in
Speaker Rtn
J6
1
2
3
J1
J7
2,6,8,10
J2
D. Gnd
Temp-TXD
NC
Temp-RXD
NC
NC
+5 V
D. Gnd
Pred. Temp.
Infrared Temp
+5
SpO2-TX
SpO2-RX
SpO2RST*
SpO2 gnd
J4
J1
P1
2,6,8,10
P1
9 V Alkaline Batt.
+
Batt. in main housing
1
J2
2
Grd
+5 Therm
P1
Transmit LED
Batt. in
handpiece
Thermometer,
Infrared hand
held device.
+
9 V Alkaline Batt.
Thermometer, J3
Batt. Grd
Predictive,
1
circuit board
Therm. Rtn
0670-00-0582 2
Thermometer,
Security
Infrared Magnet
Interface Board
0670-00-0585
part of IR cradle assembly
Receiving photocell
0997-00-0426
Key.
Outer Shield.
Red Cathode
I R Cathode
Inner shield
Cathode.
Anode
9 pin female DIN
External
Interface Conn.
Masimo SpO2 sensor
receptacle Front Panel
0012-00-1344
J2
Dump*
L Ven*
B Fast*
S Gain*
Pump
Ped
Neo
Overpr. Det*
Clear*
Gain 0
Gain 1
+15 V
Charger Off*
A Gnd
Off / On*
-15 V
AC Connected*
+12, -15 On*
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
1
3
4
5
6
7
8,9
Temp. Probe receptacle
0012-00-0953 WITH 9 V battery or
0012-00-1335 WITHOUT 9 V battery
10 11
Three circuit phone jack
Datascope
Ring
Communication
Sleeve
Tip
Connector
All other pins N/C
Accutorr Plus with Masimo
SpO2 and without SpO2
Block Diagram
Revised 12/20/00
2-5
10 11
9
7
5
1 4
VBULK, 9 to 17 VDC
EOC
EL Lite Off*
n/c
Ser. Data Out
Ser. Data In
Ser. Clock
AD Clear Send*
+5 V
+5 V Recorder
+5 V
+5 V Recorder
D Gnd
P Gnd
D Gnd
D Gnd
Ext_RXD
D Gnd
Ext_TXD
0671-00-0163
+5 V
+5 V
D Gnd
D Gnd
+15
-15
A Gnd
Pwr Gnd
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
+12 VDC
Ext_RXD
Ext_RTS
Ext_TXD
Ext_CTS
Nurse Call
D Gnd
0330-00-0025-XX
+12
Stdby
AC On
+12-15 On
Off / On
Charger Off
3 2 1
Display Bus, D0
Display Bus, D1
Display Bus, D2
Display Bus, D3
Display Bus, D4
Display Bus, D5
Display Bus, D6
Display Bus, D7
WR_LED3*
ACON LED
ACON
KEY 2
KEY 1
KEY 0
KEY D7
KEY D6
KEY D5
KEY D4
KEY D3
KEY D2
KEY D1
KEY D0
ON / OFF SW*
D Gnd
Address Bus, A2
No Connection
No Connection
Hi_Low*
LCD_Unit
+5 V
Ext_RXD
Ext_RTS
Ext_TXD
Ext_CTS
D Gnd
D Gnd
+5 V
RD
TD
CTS
RTS
CSTAT*
9 to 17 VDC Bulk
D Gnd
Nurse Call
Units without Trend display,
and No SpO2: 0331-00-0104
Batt. Fuse
4A/250
+
5x20mm
-
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
1
2
3
4
J2
100 VAC
LCD Inverter
0014-00-0180
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
J3
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
0330-00-0027-XX
-
J6
3 2 1
0670-00-0649
J2
J1
1 2 34
J8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
Units with Trend display, and
Masimo SpO2: 0331-00-0108
_
J6
_
J5 P1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
0012-00-1338
19,20 15,16 11,12 7,8 5,6 3,41,2
17,18 13,14 9,10
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
DGnd
WR Recd
DGnd
RESET
HOME
RUN
DREQ
+5V
+5VP
PGND
+5VP
PGND
0330-00-0026-XX
19,20 15,16 11,12 7,8 5,6 3,41,2
17,18 13,14 9,10
19,20 15,16 11,12 7,8 5,6 3,4 1,2
17,18 13,14 9,10
4
5
7
9
Reed Sw.
Units with Trend display, but
No SpO2: 0331-00-0102
9
7
5
4
1
Thermister
1 2 34
J5
CAPTIVE CABLE
Masimo
SpO2 Circuit
Board MS-3
J2
KEYPADS:
P Gnd
+12 V
9 7 5 4
Tone Processor Board Tone Processor Board
shown but not used in
0670-00-1134
all versions
0160-00-0034
1 2 3
Chassis Gnd
D Gnd
+5 V
View Angle Control
WR_LCD*
RD_LCD*
CS_LCD*
A<1>
D Gnd
Reset*
Bus, <0>
Bus, <1>
Bus, <2>
Bus, <3>
Bus, <4>
Bus, <5>
Bus, <6>
Bus, <7>
D Gnd
+5 V
CPU / LED Board
0670-00-0650-03 for units with SpO2
0670-00-0650-04 for units Without SpO2
Speaker
NIBP Board
0670-00-0584-02
LCD lite Off
100 VAC
return
LCD Display
Module
AC Hot
Filter Board
0670-00-0584-03
100 VAC
0146-00-0043
AC Neut
N/C
12 Volt
NIBP Pump
+12 V
0146-00-0069
+
Battery shown but
used in all versions
GRAPHIC OVERLAYS:
J7
Rtn. Switched
2. Functional blocks with dashed outlines are optional
features. (---)
3. Shaded blocks are considered
"black box" devices
Masimo SpO2
interface board
0670-00-0716
External Communication
Circuit board
0670-00-0661-01
Recorder
circuit board
0670-00-0583
CAPTIVE CABLE
Electro luminescent
panel lite
12 V Battery
Lead Acid
J4
AC Gnd
+12 V Filt
P Gnd
Pump Rtn
+12 V Nfilt
J4
3 2
1 2 3 OR
+
DC Power Supply
0014-00-0184 (SLA)
OR
0014-00-0225 (Li-Ion)
Notes:
1. Detailed functional descriptions
are found in the Theory of Operations section
10.8 V Battery
Lithium - Ion
Accutorr Plus with Masimo SpO2 or without SpO2
Interconnect Diagram
OR
Notes:
1. Detailed functional descriptions
are found in the Theory of Operations section
Accutorr Plus with Datascope SpO2 or without SpO2
Wiring Diagram
Li-Ion Batt. Cable
0997-00-0944
10.8 V Battery
Lithium - Ion
SLA Batt. Cable
0406-00-0754
2. Functional blocks with dashed outlines are optional
features. (---)
3. Shaded blocks are considered
"black box" devices
0146-00-0069
OR
-
J2
J3
+
Mains Input
0012-00-0941
Batt. Fuse
DC Power Supply
0014-00-0184 (SLA)
OR
0014-00-0225 (Li-Ion)
0012-00-0986
J6
0012-00-1015
12 Volt
NIBP Pump
Filter Board
0670-00-0584-03
J5
J4 OR J4
12 V Battery
Lead Acid
0146-00-0043
Speaker with Cable
0012-00-0257-05
0012-00-0943
CAPTIVE CABLE
CAPTIVE CABLE
J2
0012-00-0989
0160-00-0034
100 VAC
LCD Display
Module
J3
Hi Volt. Inverter
0014-00-0180
J1
0670-00-0649
Electro luminescent
panel lite
J2
NIBP Board
0670-00-0584-02
Tone Processor Board Tone Processor Board
shown but not used in
all versions.
0670-00-1134
J4
0012-00-0944
0012-00-0988
J6
J1
J8
CPU / LED Board
0670-00-0650-03 for units with SpO2
0670-00-0650-04 for units Without SpO2
J3
J2
Captive Cable,
Soldered to
CPU Circuit board.
Male / Female
Header Connector
Captive Cable soldered to the
Communication Circuit board
J5
J7
Captive Cable,
Soldered to
CPU Circuit board.
J4
0012-00-1238
P1
9 V Alkaline Batt.
+
Battery shown but not
used in all versions
1
2
_
+
9 V Alkaline Batt.
Batt. in
handpiece
Thermometer,
Infrared hand
held device.
0012-00-1223
_
J2
J3
Transmit LED
Datascope SpO2 sensor
receptacle Front Panel
Batt. in main housing
0330-00-0025-XX
1
Units without Trend display,
and No SpO2: 0331-00-0104
J3
2
0330-00-0027-XX
Reed Sw.
External
Interface Conn.
9 pin female DIN
0012-00-1090
0012-00-1089
Three circuit phone jack
Datascope
Communication
Connector
Units with Trend display, and
SpO2: 0331-00-0103
Thermometer,
Infrared
Interface Board
0670-00-0585
0330-00-0026-XX
part of IR cradle assembly
Units with Trend display, and
No SpO2: 0331-00-0102
GRAPHIC OVERLAYS:
Security
Magnet
Captive Cable,
Soldered to
Communication
Circuit board.
KEYPADS:
0997-00-0426
J3
Circuit Board
0670-00-0593-03
Receiving photocell
Recorder
circuit board
0670-00-0583
External Communication
Circuit board
0670-00-0661-01
Datascope SpO2
Thermometer,
Predictive,
circuit board
0670-00-0582
P1
P1
P1
Temp. Probe receptacle
0012-00-0953 WITH 9 V battery or
0012-00-1335 WITHOUT 9V battery
Accutorr Plus with Datascope
SpO2 or without SpO2 Wiring
Block Diagram
Revised 12/20/00
2-6
Notes:
1. Detailed functional descriptions
are found in the Theory of Operations section
Accutorr Plus with NELLCOR SpO2 or without SpO2
Wiring Diagram
Li-Ion Batt. Cable
0997-00-0944
10.8 V Battery
Lithium - Ion
SLA Batt. Cable
0406-00-0754
2. Functional blocks with dashed outlines are optional
features. (---)
3. Shaded blocks are considered
"black box" devices
0146-00-0069
OR
-
J2
J3
+
Mains Input
0012-00-0941
Batt. Fuse
DC Power Supply
0014-00-0184 (SLA)
OR
0014-00-0225 (Li-Ion)
0012-00-0986
J6
0012-00-1015
12 Volt
NIBP Pump
Filter Board
0670-00-0584-03
J5
J4 OR J4
12 V Battery
Lead Acid
0146-00-0043
Speaker with Cable
0012-00-0257-05
0012-00-0943
J1
CAPTIVE CABLE
J2
0012-00-0989
0160-00-0034
100 VAC
LCD Display
Module
J3
Hi Volt. Inverter
0014-00-0180
CAPTIVE CABLE
0670-00-0649
Electro luminescent
panel lite
J2
NIBP Board
0670-00-0584-02
Tone Processor Board Tone Processor Board
shown but not used in
all versions
0670-00-1134
J4
0012-00-0944
0012-00-0988
J6
J1
J8
CPU / LED Board
0670-00-0650-03 for units with SpO2
0670-00-0650-04 for units Without SpO2
J3
J2
J7
0012-00-1238
Captive Cable,
Soldered to
CPU Circuit board.
Captive Cable soldered to the
Communication Circuit board
J5
9 V Alkaline Batt.
_
+
Battery shown but not
used in all versions
1
2
0330-00-0025-XX
1
Units without Trend display,
and No SpO2: 0331-00-0104
2
0330-00-0027-XX
Batt. in main housing
0671-00-0162
Units with Trend display, and
NELLCOR SpO2: 0331-00-0108
Thermometer,
Predictive,
circuit board
0670-00-0582
0330-00-0026-XX
Thermometer,
Infrared
Interface Board
0670-00-0585
Units with Trend display, and
No SpO2: 0331-00-0102
Security
Magnet
Captive Cable,
Soldered to
Communication
Circuit board.
GRAPHIC OVERLAYS:
part of IR cradle assembly
J3
KEYPADS:
NELLCOR
SpO2 Circuit
Board MP304
P1
P1
Receiving photocell
Recorder
circuit board
0670-00-0583
External Communication
Circuit board
0670-00-0661-01
J1
NELLCOR SpO2
interface board
0670-00-0675
0997-00-0426
P1
Male / Female
Header Connector
Captive Cable,
Soldered to
CPU Circuit board.
J4
J3
_
+
9 V Alkaline Batt.
Batt. in
handpiece
Thermometer,
Infrared hand
held device.
0012-00-1222-01
Transmit LED
NELLCOR SpO2 sensor
receptacle Front Panel
Reed Sw.
9 pin female DIN
0012-00-1090
Datascope
Communication
Connector
0012-00-1089
Three circuit phone jack
External
Interface Conn.
J2
J3
P1
Temp. Probe receptacle
0012-00-0953 WITH 9V battery or
0012-00-1335 WITHOUT 9V battery
Accutorr Plus with NELLCOR
SpO 2 or without SpO2 Wiring
Block Diagram
Revised 12/20/00
2-7
Notes:
1. Detailed functional descriptions
are found in the Theory of Operations section
Accutorr Plus with Masimo SpO2 or without SpO2
Wiring Diagram
Li-Ion Batt. Cable
0997-00-0944
10.8 V Battery
Lithium - Ion
SLA Batt. Cable
0406-00-0754
2. Functional blocks with dashed outlines are optional
features. (---)
3. Shaded blocks are considered
"black box" devices
0146-00-0069
OR
-
J2
J3
+
J6
Mains Input
0012-00-0941
Batt. Fuse
DC Power Supply
0014-00-0184 (SLA)
OR
0014-00-0225 (Li-Ion)
0012-00-0986
Filter Board
0670-00-0584-03
0012-00-1015
12 Volt
NIBP Pump
J5
J4 OR J4
12 V Battery
Lead Acid
0146-00-0043
Speaker with Cable
0012-00-0257-05
0012-00-0943
J1
CAPTIVE CABLE
J2
0012-00-0989
0160-00-0034
100 VAC
LCD Display
Module
J3
Hi Volt. Inverter
0014-00-0180
CAPTIVE CABLE
0670-00-0649
Electro luminescent
panel lite
J2
NIBP Board
0670-00-0584-02
Tone Processor Board Tone Processor Board
J4
shown but not used in
all versions.
0670-00-1134
0012-00-0944
0012-00-0988
J6
J1
J8
CPU / LED Board
0670-00-0650-03 for units with SpO2
0670-00-0650-04 for units Without SpO2
J3
J2
J7
0012-00-1238
Captive Cable,
Soldered to
CPU Circuit board.
Male / Female
Header Connector
Captive cable soldered to the
Communication Circuit board
J5
Captive Cable,
Soldered to
CPU Circuit board.
J4
J1
Masimo SpO2
interface board
0670-00-0716
9 V Alkaline Batt.
_
+
Batt. in main housing
Thermometer,
Predictive,
circuit board
0670-00-0582
J5
0330-00-0027-XX
Battery shown but not
used in all versions
1
2
1
2
Thermometer,
Infrared
Interface Board
0670-00-0585
Units with Trend display, and
Masimo SpO2: 0331-00-0108
0330-00-0026-XX
part of IR cradle assembly
Units with Trend display, and
No SpO2: 0331-00-0102
GRAPHIC OVERLAYS:
Security
Magnet
Captive Cable,
Soldered to
Communication
Circuit board.
KEYPADS:
Masimo
SpO2 Circuit
Board MS-3
0671-00-0163
0997-00-0426
J3
0012-00-1338
Receiving photocell
Recorder
circuit board
0670-00-0583
External Communication
Circuit board
0670-00-0661-01
P1
P1
J2
P1
J6
J2
J3
0330-00-0025-XX
_
+
9 V Alkaline Batt.
Batt. in
handpiece
Thermometer,
Infrared hand
held device.
Transmit LED
Masimo SpO2 sensor
receptacle Front Panel
0012-00-1344
Reed Sw.
External
Interface Conn.
9 pin female DIN
0012-00-1090
0012-00-1089
Three circuit phone jack
Datascope
Communication
Connector
Units without Trend display,
and No SpO2: 0331-00-0104
P1
Temp. Probe receptacle
0012-00-0953 WITH 9V battery or
0012-00-1335 WITHOUT 9V battery
Accutorr Plus with Masimo
SpO2 or without SpO2 Wiring
Block Diagram
Revised 12/20/00
2-8
2.2.1 LED/CPU Module - 0670-00-0650-03, -04
The 0670-00-0650-03 is specified to be used with the Accutorr Plus NIBP with Trend
Screen and SpO2. The 0670-00-0650-04 is specified to be used with Accutorr Plus
NIBP and the Accutorr Plus NIBP with Trend Screen.
Resource Control Register
Systolic
Keypad
SPO2RST*
MAP
A(2)
12+-15ON
CHRGOFF
7
7
7
3
Room
Number
Diastolic
6
2
6
6
3
Pulse Rate
1
8
Bed
Number
2
1
Seg.
8
Digit
5
3
2
1
8
Seg.
8
+15V
-15V
10
pin
J7
Digit
0
SPO2
SPO2
Seg.
8
+5V
4
SPO2_TXD
4
Digit
8
20
pin
J5
U?
ACONLED
From 1 2 Volt Ba t t ery
4 Volt
Regulator
U17
RTC W/
4kX8 NVRAM
U28
RESET*
Disable
5
GAIN1
CLEAR*
SER_DI
TxD2
SERIAL CLOCK
CONTROL U13
SPCLK
SPCLKEN*
NEO
Oscilla t or
1 6 . 0 0 Mhz
U2
CLK
Battery
Backup
Control
U19
SRAM
512k x 16
U4,U5
Valve &
Pump
Control
U13,U14,U16
SER_DO
SCP
PIO
ACON
CSTAT*
EXT_CTS
RxD
RS232ENB*
34
pin
J1
ACON*
+5 volts
ON/OFFSW*
Audio Volume Control &
Speaker Driver Circuitry
U24, U25
TxD
LCD View Angle Control
Circuitry U23, Q8, Q9
VBULK
CSTAT*
-15 volts
3
pin
J6
2
LCD
VEE
VCC
WR_LCD*
VCC
EXT_RTS
TEMP_TxD
CHRGOFF*
Speaker
Dual D/A
Converter
U22
Tri-State
Transceiver
TEMP_RxD
OFF/ON*
+15 volts
RST*
UART
TYMP*
VBULK
Bus
CPU
TxD3
TxD1
CTS1*
RxD3
RxD1
RTS1*
PRED*
Power Supply
Power
On/Off
Latch
Q5
+12 volts
Flash
Memory
512k x 16
U3, U27
RxD2
68302
Microcontroller
Temperature
Probe
20
pin
J4
WR_RECD*
Data
16
Over
Pressure
Latch
U15
GAIN0
PART OF J1
HI_LOW*
LCD_UNIT*
Power On
Reset
U2
NIBP/POWER
PED
HOME*
DREQ*
WR_RECD*
RUN*
RECD*
RESET*
VCC, +5VP
RST*
A
SER_CLK
U?
Recorder
SPO2*
PRED*
TYMP*
RECD*
U2
4
SPO2*
34
pin
J1
30
pin
J2
8
U2
Digit
Driver
U8
SPO2_RXD
OVPR_DET*
16
LEDs
8
WR_LED3*
Digit
Driver
U9
SPO2RST*
D
18
keys
Configuration Port
Temp/Time/Interval
5
U7
ACONLED
ACON*
ON/OFFSW*
U6
Digit
Driver
U10
0
8
5
3
Keypad Port
0
RS 232
Xceivers
U26
3
20
pin
J3
Central Station
Port
RD_LCD*
CS_LCD*
20
pin
J8
A(2)
Serial
Port
Figure 2-3
RESET*
D(7..0)
LED/CPU
Block Diagram
2.2.1.1 Hardware Overview
The Accutorr Plus LED/CPU module controls the functions of the NIBP, receives input
data from the keypad, temperature probes and SpO2 module, transmits output data to
the recorder, drives the LCD display, speaker, and LEDs, is an interface connection for
central station support and has a serial I/O port for PC communication.
2.2.1.2 Software Overview
The software performs the following functions:
1. Initialize hardware and software modules.
· microcontroller ports and communications (serial) interfaces
· software entry points and variables
2. Perform power up diagnostics.
· microcontroller, FLASH, and STATIC RAM tests
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 2 - Theory of Operation
Revised 12/20/00
2-9
3. Perform NIBP functions.
· start measurement
· determine inflation pressure
· repeat measurement
· perform controlled cuff deflation
· overpressure limit
· monitor DC and AC pressure and
· enter or exit text mode
· abort measurement
· enter or exit calibration mode
· update alarm limits
· report alarm status
acquire pulsations
· decide on termination point and
exhaust cuff pressure
· smooth pulsation data
· determine systolic, mean, diastolic
pressure and heart rate
· check alarm conditions
· report data
4. Transmit/Receive data to/from Temperature module.
5. Manage Recorder functions.
6. Manage Keypad interface.
7. Drive Seven Segment LED.
8. Provide RS232 communications to PC and support software download.
9. Support Service Diagnostics.
2.2.1.3
Detailed Hardware Description
Microcontroller, U1
Device U1 is an MC68302, which contains a 68000 core CPU, a 24-bit address bus and
a 16-bit data bus. Clock oscillator, Y2, shall operate at a clock speed of 16MHz which is
used to clock U1. Three serial channels are used. One for communication to the
temperature modules via J4. The second for communication to an external port for PC
applications via J3. The third for communication to the SpO2 module. The MC68302
also offers a Serial Communication Port (SCP), which interfaces to the NIBP A/D. The
recorder interface is via the IDMA channel with buffering through a transceiver of all
data to the recorder.
The power-on reset to the microcontroller and the rest of the system is generated by a
DS1239 micromanager (U19). The DS1239 also acts as a watchdog to the microcontroller.
The ST* input must see a high to low transition every 100ms maximum by the
ST_WDOG* signal (an addressable signal from the microcontroller), otherwise a reset
will be generated.
Upon a reset, both RESET* and HALT* will be activated through buffer U18
(74HCT125). These signals are bi-directional at the MC68302, therefore U1 could
perform a system reset.
2-10
Revised 12/20/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 2 - Theory of Operation
Multiple power and ground pins are used on the microcontoller. All VCC pins get a
bypass capacitor to keep the local power supply quiet.
The following is a signal description for the MC68302 as it is being used in the
Accutorr Plus:
FUNCTIONAL GROUP
Clocks
System Control
Address Bus
Data Bus
Bus Control
Interrupt Control
SIGNALS
EXTAL
RESET*
HALT*
BERR*
BUSW
DISCPU
A23-A1
D15-D0
AS*
R/W*
SIGNAL DESCRIPTION
Oscillator input
Microcontroller Reset
Microcontroller Halt
Bus Error
Bus Width Select
Disable CPU
Bi-directional addr bus
Bi-directional data bus
Address Strobe
Read/Write
I/O
I
I/O
I/O
I/O
I
I
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
UDS*, LDS*
DTACK*
IRQ1*, IRQ6*,
IRQ7*
IRQ7*
Upper/Lower Data strobe
Data Transfer Acknowledge
Dedicated interrupts,
edge-sensitive
PWR_OFF* (Power failure)
DONE* (DMA done)
OVPR* (NIBP overpressure)
Chip Select lines
SER_DO (NIBP A/D data
out)
SER_DI (NIBP A/D data in)
SPCLK (NIBP A/D clock)
EXT_RD (Receive data)
EXT_TD (Transmit data)
EXT_CTS* (Clear to Send)
EXT_RTS* (Request to
Send)
SPO2_TXD (SPO2 xmit)
SPO2_RXD (SPO2 rec’d)
NEO (NIBP Neonate select)
PED (NIBP Pediatric select)
SGAIN (NIBP
Pressure Gain)
BFAST (NIBP Bleed fast)
LVEN (NIBP Linear Valve
enable)
DUMP (NIBP Dump
valve)
TEMP_TXD (TEMP
receive data)
TEMP_RXD (TEMP
transmit data)
GAIN0 (NIBP Pulse Gain)
GAIN1 (NIBP Pulse Gain)
CLEAR* (Reset NIBP pulse)
I/O
I/O
I
low
h-read
l-write
low
low
low
I
low
I
I
O
I
low
low
low
IRQ6*
IRQ1*
CS0* - CS3*
Chip Select
Serial Communications SPRXD
Port
SPTXD
SPCLK
RXD1
Channel 1 UART
TXD1
CTSI*
RTS1*
Channel 2
UART/Port A
RXD2/PA0
TXD2/PA1
PA2
PA3
PA4
PA5
PA6
PA7
RXD3/PA8
TXD3/PA9
PA10
PA11
PA12
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 2 - Theory of Operation
O
O
I
O
I
O
ACTIVE
high
low
low
low
h-16 bit
high
high
I
O
O
O
O
high
high
high
O
O
high
high
O
high
I
O
O
O
O
high
high
low
Revised 12/20/00
2-11
FUNCTIONAL GROUP
Channel 2
UART/Port A
Port B
SIGNALS
PA13/DREQ*
PA14
PA15
PB0
PB1
PB2
PB3
PB4
PB5
PB6
PB7
PB8
PB9
PB10
PB11
SIGNAL DESCRIPTION
DREQ* (Recorder DMA
Request)
AD_CS* (NIBP A/D CS)
DONE* (DMA done)
ELOFF* (LCD Backlight
off)
ACON (AC on)
SPCLKEN* (SP Clk enable)
ENPNEU*
RS232ENB*
DSP-CONT*
TONE
PUMP_ON (NIBP pump
on)
CSTAT* (RS232)
HOME* (Recorder print
head home)
RUN* (Recorder motor on)
EOC (NIBP A/D End of
Conversion)
I/O
I
ACTIVE
low
O
O
O
low
low
low
I
O
O
O
O
O
O
high
low
low
low
low
high
high
O
I
low
low
O
I
low
high
Address and Data Bus Dampening
Dampening resistors have been added to all Address and Data Bus lines that provide
control and interface to I/O devices and the LCD, on CS2 and CS3. All address lines and
data bus lines used for the Flash, SRAM and RTC/NV Ram do not have dampenig resistors.
The dampening resistors are to located as close to the microcontroller, U1, as possible.
Flash memories, U3, U27
Program code is stored in two flash memories, ie., SST 28SF040, 512K x 8 addressed as
upper and lower sector addressable to 256 bytes. These devices allow in circuit
programmability, which will allow easy upgrades to software revisions. CS_FLSH*, will
chip select these memories. Flash memory chip U3 is the Even byte and U27 is the odd
byte.
Worst case for CS_FLSH* to data valid is 150ns max. Data must be valid 15ns min
before MC68302 S6 falling edge. With one wait state inserted, 3.5 clock periods will
occur before S6 falling edge. Therefore data will be ready 48.25ns before S6 falling edge,
which will meet the requirement of 15ns min.
2-12
Revised 12/20/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 2 - Theory of Operation
CMOS SRAM, U4, U5
This memory made up of two 512K x 8 SRAMs, U4, and U5. The memories are
non-volatile due to the circuitry of Micromanager U19, and the Primary Battery Backup
Voltage Regulator, consisting of Q7, and U17. The timing for the two SRAM’s are the
same. The SRAM write condition will be looked at first.
CS_RAM* must be active low 90 ns min before WR* rising edge. CS_RAM* is active
40ns max from S2 rising edge. WR* rising edge occurs when S6 falling edge occurs.
With one wait state, as above for the flash memories, there will be 3.5 clock periods.
Therefore, CS_RAM* will be active 168.25ns, compared to requirement of 90ns min.
This will meet the write timing.
CS_RAM* to data valid is 55ns max for SRAM read. Data will be valid 162.5ns max
from CS_RAM* active low. Therefore, with 3.5 clock periods to S6 falling edge, data
will be valid 68.25ns before S6 falling edge. This will meet the setup to S6 falling edge
of 15ns min.
Battery Backup Circuit
U17 is a 4V regulator which must supply current during battery mode. It supports the
Real Time Clock, U28, Micromanager, U19, and the two SRAM’s. The RTC will draw
1uA, Micromanager, 20uA, and the SRAM’s, 200uA. Total current draw from U17 is
221uA max. U17 can supply 30mA @ Vin=6V. VBULK can supply 21mA max at the
minimal voltage of 9.77V. The current supplied by U17 will then be minimized to
21mA.
U17 maximum input voltage is 14V. The maximum voltage at VBULK is 17V. Therefore,
a resistor divider network of R11 and R12 is used in conjunction with Q7 to lower the
voltage at U17-2. The maximum voltage at the Q7 base is 10.42V. Minimum Vbe for
Q7 is 0.65V. Maximum Vin will be 9.77V, which is lower than 14V as discussed above.
Micromanager, U19
The micromanager is a DS1239. It performs four functions:
1.
2.
3.
4.
System power on/off capability.
Watchdog functions.
Create CMOS SRAM to Non-volatile memory.
Power monitoring of VCC.
The MC68302 specifies to be held in reset for 100ms min upon power up. The DS1239
can hold the reset line, active low for 25ms min. In order to hold the reset line down for
100ms min, then the addition of a capacitor to the PBRST* input is needed. The
minimum time for the PBRST* input to reach 2.0V, logic hi to turn on unit, with a
47uF capacitor is 142ms.
The watchdog is monitored on U19-11. The maximum strobe period is 100ms. Therefore,
in order for the device not to reset the system, U19-11 must be strobed 100ms max.
The DS1239 can supply 1mA through U19-2, VCC_BACK, during battery mode. The
SRAM’s will draw 200uA max during battery mode.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 2 - Theory of Operation
Revised 12/20/00
2-13
Real Time Clock and NV RAM (RTC), U28
The RTC is a bus device that will keep track of seconds, minutes, hours, date of the
month, month, day of the week, and year with leap year compensation. The module
contains a 10 year lithium source and internal crystal. The independent Lithium battery
is a back up so that in case AC power is not on, the battery voltage will keep the time up
to date.
Also included in the device is 2K X 8 nonvolatile RAM. This ram is continuous addressed
above the RTC information.
NIBP Control, U13, U14, U15, U16
U15 is used to create an over pressure latch, that will monitor OVPR_DET*, for a hardware over pressure situation. When this circuit is tripped, the pneumatic drivers will be
disengaged, and no NIBP functions will exist until a power-on reset occurs. The over
pressure signal may have inadvertent triggers. In order for OVPR_DET* to trigger the
latch, it must be active low for 66ms min, due to C11, R16, and R15.
U15, also is used for a pneumatic safety latch. In the case of a MC68302 clock failure, the
pneumatic drivers will be disengaged upon a power-on reset. If the clock is running, then
the software will toggle EN_PNEU*, to enable the drivers and NIBP functions will work.
Upon power on reset, the following sequence must be met in order for the over pressure
and pneumatic safety latches to be initialized properly: U15-1 must go to a logic hi 76ns
min before RST* rises to a logic hi, and RST* must go to a logic hi 76ns min before
EN_PNEU* toggles logic low to a logic hi. The pneumatic drivers are made up of U14,
U13, and U16. These gates are used for the turn on of the pump, dump valve, linear
valve, and other controls. As discussed above, they will only work given the proper
initialization or no fault condition.
The serial clock to the NIBP A/D, TLC2543, is controlled via U13. SPCLK comes from
the SCP of the MC68302 and is gated by SPCLKEN* to form SER_CLK. SPCLK cannot
be higher than 4.1MHz. AD_CS* is the enable to the chip select input of the device.
EOC is an output signal of the A/D, and specifies an end of conversion. It goes hi to low
and remains low until a conversion is completed and data is ready for transfer. AD_CS*
must be active low for 1.425us before SER_CLK starts toggling. EOC will go low 2.2us
max from last SER_CLK.
Recorder interface
The recorder interface is a buffered 8 bit parallel data bus with handshaking and reset
capability through connector J5. The buffering provides pass through filtering and ESD
suppression is provided by U35. WR_RECD* is driven by the LED/CPU board and used
by the recorder to latch the data bus. This interface is handled by the DMA capability of
the MC68302. The recorder drives two signals, DREQ*, and HOME*. DREQ* specifies
to the MC68302 to send the next byte of data. HOME* will specify when the recorder
has reached its starting point to begin a new line.
2-14
Revised 12/20/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 2 - Theory of Operation
Temperature interface
This is a serial interface operating in one direction. The MC68302 is set up to receive
serial information through connector, J4. The signals are TTL levels. Also, this connector
will accept two temperature modules, one a Predictive, the other, an Infrared module.
The software will query the MC68302 ports to determine if and what temperature
module is installed. When the Predictive module is attached, PRED* is pulled to active
low. When the Infrared module is attached, TYMP* is pulled to active low.
LED Drivers, U8, U9, U10 and U1 on the Keypanel
The seven segment LED’s, and green LED’s on the keypad are driven by four MAXIM
ICM7218A LED Display Drivers, three on the CPU board and one on the keypad.
These drivers accept parallel data in a serial format and drive common anode displays.
A ‘no decode’ feature is available on this device which allows for greater flexibility in
controlling each individual segment. The writes are performed via U11. The scan rate
of the LED’s is 250 Hz, with a duty time of 500us, typically. Also, the drivers can enter
a shutdown mode, where typically 10uA is needed per device. The write signals,
WR_LED(0..3)*, must be active low for 200ns min. Data bus, D(0..7) must be setup
250ns with respect to the write signal rising edge. The LED drivers are mapped to the
CS_IO* of the MC68302 and is configured for 4 wait states. As discussed above,
WR_LED0* must be active low for 200ns min. WR_LED0* will become active upon
DS* going low. DS* will go low 41ns after S4 rising edge. There will be 5.5 clock
periods from S4 rising edge. This amounts to 343.75ns - 41ns = 302.75ns min that
WR_LED0* will be active low for. This meets the write strobe timing. As discussed
above, data must be valid 250ns to WR_LED0* rising edge. Data is written by the
MC68302 30ns after S4 rising edge. S4 rising edge to S6 falling edge is 343.75ns.
Therefore, data is valid 313.75ns min before WR_LED0* rising edge, which is greater
than 250ns.
DS1-DS6 are 7 segment 0.8" high Red LEDs. DS7-DS9 are 7 segment 0.56" high Red
LEDs. DS10-DS12 are 7 segment 0.56" high green LEDs. DS13-DS15 are 4 digit 7
segment 0.28" high red LEDs, with a upper and lower colon. The driver lines for DS10 DS12 are latched and driven by individual 74HC374A with each output driving a
segment through current limiting resistors sized for the mcd intensity of each color.
The data is latched by using a 74HC123 inverted output is used to latch the data. The
trigger is the multiplexed anode line from the Maxim IC and the output state change is
delayed a minimum of 40uS and a maximum of 200uS. This will enable the latch from
10 to 50% into the multiplx line.
The discrete LEDs on the keypad are driven by WR_LED3* which is located on the
keypad. For the purpose of design control the device is contained within these design
documents. This device is used to illuminate the individual LEDs on the keypad.
The timing and function is the same as above.
The display controllers are 8 bit devices located on the odd address locations defined in
Appendix A2. An additional data bus line, D8, is used to enable the display drivers for
the SpO2 and Heart Rate. The bit is written to by either the control or data registars.
The device is enabled by a high signal on D8 that is clocked in by RST_WR_LED
(0..2)*.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 2 - Theory of Operation
Revised 12/20/00
2-15
Keypad interface
The keypad is made up of a 3 x 8 matrix of keys. U6 will monitor the array of 8 keys. It
is pulled up and when a key is pressed, one of those lines will go low. An interrogation
will commence from the MC68302 to find which key was pressed.
Communication Interface
The Accutorr Plus Communication module provides the communication signal interface
between the LED/CPU board and the external communication interface connector. The
board supports the CIS/HIS/DIAP interface via RS-232E or RS-485, providing a feed
through path for the Datascope proprietary download connector (J1), the DC/DC converter
(for the =12Vdc @ 100mA required for wireless telemetry), and the RS-232 driver.
SpO2 Interface
The SpO2 module connects to the LED/CPU module via connector J7. Power, ie., æ15V
and +5V, and ground are provided by the LED/CPU module. The MC68302, interfaces
with the SCC2692 of the SpO2 module through a TTL serial interface. The SpO2 module
sends serial information via signal, SpO2_TXD, and receives information via signal,
SpO2_RXD. The LED/CPU module can reset the SpO2 module by asserting
SpO2RST*. The signal SpO2* is used to provide the LED/CPU with the systolic signal
used to create the heart beat.
DAC functions
U22 is a dual 8 bit DAC, that interfaces to U1, MC68302. It controls the attenuation
needed for the speaker driver circuitry and the amplitude of LCD drive signal, VEE, ie.,
steps of 255 from 0 to -10.4 V minimum. The device is selected via the CS_IO* signal.
Power to the DAC is provided by an unboard DC-DC convertor. The DAC is written to
when WR_DDAC* pulses hi when CS_IO* is active low. Timing is equivalent to that
discussed in section 2.3.10.
Speaker Driver
This function is driven by the MC68302 in two manners. One is the enable signal,
TONE, and the other will attenuate the output signal in steps of 255 via the data bus,
D(0..7). TONE is a 5V signal which is divided down by 26 to 200mV and buffered by
U24, LM358. This signal is then attenuated by U22, AD7528, and buffered by the other
half of U24. U25 is the speaker driver section and this amplifier is set for a gain of 20.
LCD
The LCD drive supply voltage is specified for -10.4V minimum. It can go to a maximum
of 17V with respect to VDD logic supply voltage. The DAC, U22 will take +15VF as
reference voltage and feed that to TL032, U23, to invert to -15V output. That is then
buffered by another section of U23 and drive base of Q9. Transistor Q8 is set up as a
current limiter for Q9. It monitors the current across R32. If the voltage across R32 is
greater than 0.7V, ie., 21mA, then shunt drive voltage to the base of Q9 to limit the current.
2-16
Revised 12/20/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 2 - Theory of Operation
Power ON Tone
The power on tone is used to inform the user the unit is powered on. The speakers
amplifier is driven by an oscillator for a min. 70 mS. The device is triggered by either a
press of the ON/STBY key, turning the unit on, or a reset condition. The oscillator is
designed to run at approximately 600hz.
Central Station
The microcontroller has control over the external serial communications with CSTAT*
and RS232ENB*. The board includes a connector, shared with the RS232, for connection to
an interface PCB. This interface includes RD, TD, RTS, and CTS for communication,
VBULK which is the main battery voltage, VCC for logic drive, CSTAT* for control of
the interface status and DGND. VBULK is capable of supplying 1 watt of power to this
module.
2.2.2 NIBP Module, Linear Bleed
Overview
The NIBP module contains only the Pneumatic and the Analog circuits. The NIBP
module is controlled by the CPU on the LED/CPU module. All analog signals are
converted by an on board serial A/D converter and sent serially to the CPU for processing.
The NIBP module, in conjunction with the LED/CPU module, measures the blood
pressure non-invasively using an inflatable cuff and the oscillometric principle.
The NIBP module is controlled by the CPU where it inflates the cuff, bleeds down the
cuff pressure during measurement and engages the dump valve which relieves cuff pressure
at the conclusion of the measurement. It monitors the air pressure in the cuff via a pressure
transducer. It is from this signal (both AC and DC components) that it determines the
NIBP of the patient via the oscillometric principle. Safety features include a hardware over
pressure limit set to the corresponding limit depending on patient size selected via the
control panel. This hardware pressure limit is in addition to a software controlled limit
which will provide redundant fail safe operation upon a fault condition.
The “Linear Bleed” NIBP module has a single proportional valve, having a continuously
variable effective orifice size. This valve is controlled by a servo loop, such that the cuff
deflation rate is closely and automatically regulated to a specified value, despite changes in
the cuff volume and pressure.
In addition, the NIBP module distributes the power from the power supply, which
includes power and control signals to the LED/CPU module. Via the LED/CPU board,
power is distributed to the rest of the system, such as the Recorder and the SpO2
modules. Also, the NIBP module supplies separate power and control to: a) Pump filter
board, which powers the NIBP pump. b) LCD back light converter.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 2 - Theory of Operation
Revised 12/20/00
2-17
Software Control
There are no software requirements on this board. The microcontroller for this board’s
functions are located on the LED/CPU board.
Hardware Functions
Pressure transducer circuitry
A pressure transducer and amplifier is provided to acquire the cuff pressure signal.
Performance is consistent with pressure range and accuracy specifications for the NIBP
module.
Over pressure transducer circuitry
An over pressure transducer, independent of the main pressure transducer is provided. An
amplifier, a comparator with three selectable over pressure limits, and an over
pressure output signal interpret the transducer state. Over pressure limits are set
according to the patient size.
Five A/D channels
All channels are at 12 bit resolution and digitized at 300 Hz:
1) DC pressure
2) AC pressure (pulse)
3) Hardware over pressure transducer
4) Hardware over pressure comparator reference.
5) Battery voltage monitoring, when the Accutorr is in battery operation.
Pulse Channel Filter
A high-pass filter is provided to isolate the pulsatile component from the DC cuff
pressure. This pulsatile component is digitized as the pulse channel. The gain of this
AC coupled channel is programmable in a manner consistent with the specified range
of pulse amplitudes. Means are provided to rapidly “reset” the filter following
disturbances caused by motion or activation of the pump or valves.
Inflation Pump
A pump capable of inflating the cuff within the specified time limit.
Bleed Valve
A valve and control system capable of bleeding down the cuff pressure in accordance with
the specifications.
Dump Valve
A valve to rapidly discharge the residual cuff pressure at the end of the measurement cycle.
2-18
Revised 12/20/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 2 - Theory of Operation
Figure 2-4
NIBP
Block Diagram
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 2 - Theory of Operation
Revised 12/20/00
2-19
2.2.3 Recorder Module
Accutorr Plus Recorder module provides the interface from the LED/CPU module to the
recorder. This module is strictly an output device for the Accutorr Plus. Data is written
to the module via DMA and is then routed out to the recorder.
Software Control
There are no software requirements on this board. The microcontroller for this board’s
functions are located on the LED/CPU board.
Hardware Functions
Recorder Driver Circuit Board
This circuit takes all control instructions from the LED/CPU board and provides
printhead drive decoding, paper drive motor control logic decoding, printhead “home
switch” position sensing and pulse width modulated oscillator for print head drive.
Recorder Transport and Print Assembly
This mechanical assembly has no active electronic components. A paper drive motor,
print head shuttle and print head position sensor report to the Recorder Driver circuit
board.
Figure 2-5
Recorder Module
Control Logic
Block Diagram
2-20
Revised 12/20/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 2 - Theory of Operation
2.2.4 Predictive Thermometer Module
Overview
The Accutorr Predictive Thermometer Module, is an optional accessory to the
Accutorr Plus or Plus with SpO2.
The Predictive Thermometer PCB consists of 2 68HC705C8A microcontrollers (MCU)
IC’s (U4 and U3). MCU U2, is provided by Sherwood Medical, and its software program
converts the thermistor output signal to a seven segment code used to drive a display.
The second MCU U3 software program, converts the seven segment code to a serial
TTL-level signal, that is isolated from the main Accutorr Monitor via opto-isolators.
Block Diagram
An overall block diagram of the Predictive Thermometer PCB is shown below. The
Predictive Thermometer PCB consists mainly of a differential amplifier (ICL7612), an
A/D converter (ADC0834B) and 2 microcontroller IC’s that convert the analog signal of
the input temperature probe to a serial TTL-level signal.
Software Control
The determination and processing software within the module is adapted under license
from an outside vendor, as part of U4. Software control of data communicated to the
LED/CPU board for further processing and display control.
Figure 2-6
Predicative Temperature
Module Block Diagram
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 2 - Theory of Operation
Revised 12/20/00
2-21
2.2.5 SpO2 Module: (Accutorr Plus Model with Datascope SpO2 only)
General Theory of SpO2 determination: A pulsatile arterial saturated oxygen monitor
detects the oxygenation level of the blood in the body’s arterial circulation. It is used to
continuously monitor the effectiveness of the pulmonary system (lungs). Specifically the
device, within limits, determines the fraction of hemoglobin molecules carrying oxygen
from the lungs to the body cells. Termed % SpO2, this fraction is normally about 97 percent.
The device measures the relative attenuation of two specific wavelengths of light (red and
infrared) by the arterial blood. A sensor from the instrument contains two sets of LED’s
to illuminate a portion of the body (e.g., a fingertip), and a single photo-detector to sense
the amount of light which exits. The two sets of LED’s are alternately pulsed so that the
circuitry can discriminate the infrared light. Each time the heart pulses arterial blood
into the finger, the photo-detector’s signals return to their original level. The electronic
instrumentation processes only this changing portion of the photo-detector’s outputs.
Thus, arterial blood (not skin, bone, venous blood, etc.).
The determination is based upon the assumption that hemoglobin and oxyhemoglobin are
the only two significant attenuators of light in the arterial blood. The device exploits the
difference in their optical attenuation characteristics. But since the detector’s signal is sensitive
to the combined attenuation of both molecules, the device must use two different wavelengths
to discriminate their individual contributions, and thus their relative concentration.
The SpO2 Module allows the Accutorr Plus Model with SpO2 to measure patient’s blood
stream saturated pulsatile oxygen level and pulse rate.
Datascope SpO2 Module Theory of Operation, Electrical Description
The SpO2 board consists of analog and digital sections. The analog section provides all
the patient finger probe excitation and analog signal processing. The digital section
controls the operation of the analog part of the board and provides communication to the
rest of the Accutorr Plus with SpO2 via the U14 DUART.
Analog Section
The operation of the analog section is controlled by the digital part of the board by:
· Supplying CLKSEQ clock signal to the sequencer.
· Latching signals D0..7, into control register with strobe signals
CONTROL-REG0*, CONTROL-REG1*, and CONTROL-REG2*.
· Monitoring COMP* and SAT* signals.
The sequencer controls the front end of analog section. It provides RD-DRV and IR-DRV
signals for the LED drive circuit, which in turn alternately drive red and infrared LED
emitters in the probe. A single photo-detector on the opposite side of the finger
produces current pulses proportional to the amount of light received. The sequencer also
sets the gain of the current to voltage pre-amp and controls the demultiplexer. Gain
values for current to voltage pre-amp are derived from control register signals IR0, IR1,
RD0, and RD1. The fact that the sequencer has synchronous control of LED drive, gain
of current to voltage pre-amp, and demultiplexer makes it possible to set different
current to voltage gain values for infrared and red signals.
The control registers provide data for the DAC and set gain values of dc gain (DCG0,
DCG1), ac gain (ACG0, ACG1), and current to voltage pre-amp (IR0, IR1, RD0, RD1)
2-22
Revised 12/20/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 2 - Theory of Operation
stages. Wide gain range gives the board enough flexibility to acquire signals from fingers
spanning a wide range of thicknesses or alternatively from other sites of the body such as ears,
nose or toes. It also controls the remultiplexer (CHNLMUX) and provides calibration signal
CAL*, which is used by the sequencer to determine the operation mode, and test signal
DIAG*, which supplies a fixed voltage source at demultiplexer input for circuit diagnostics.
Again because the control registers can synchronously control the remultiplexer and gain values
for ac and dc gain stages, different gain settings can be selected for red and infrared signals.
An interference detector monitors the output of current to voltage preamp for voltages less than
negative 7.2 V in amplitude. This information is sent to the digital section through SAT* signal.
The patient probe signal enters the board as current pulses. After the signal goes through
the current to voltage preamp stage it is separated by the demultiplexer circuit, which
steers each voltage pulse to one of two signals, IR-CH or RD-CH. In addition, the circuit
sends a negatively amplified version of the signal level between LED pulses to both
channels. This residual signal is caused by ambient light on the photo-detector and offset
voltages from the preceding circuitry. The negative amplification sets-up cancellation of
the extraneous effect of the residual signal by the filter circuits that follow.
Signals IR-CH and RD-CH are then filtered identically by two parallel and matched
filters. The filters also reduce the effect of any noise source, which might interfere with
the measurement, such as an electro-surgical unit.
After passing through filter blocks red and infrared signals and are alternately selected
by the remultiplexer for further processing. Next, the signal is amplified by the dc gain
stage. Having the ability to apply a different gain to the two components, this block
functions as a coarse equalization of the multiplexed signal.
An offset voltage, determined by the DAC, is then subtracted by the subtraction circuit. The
plethysmographic waveform consists of a small component varying along with the physiological
pulse, sitting on top of a larger pedestal. The subtraction circuit pulls off most of this pedestal.
The subtraction circuit also helps to maintain the resultant signal in the amplifier linear region.
The residual multiplexed signal is once again processed through a microprocessor
controlled ac gain block. One of a few discrete gains is chosen for each of the two
components, such that the peak to peak size of the physiologically varying components
is large enough to be digitized with sufficient resolution.
After passing through the ac gain stage the signal is sampled by a sample and hold and
held for amplitude digitization. The digitization is performed under the microprocessor
control of the digital to analog converter. The DAC voltage is successively altered by the
microprocessor until it zones in on the signal being digitized. A comparator then
compares the signal and DAC voltages and sends COMP* signal to the digital section.
The DAC thus performs a dual function. It is used in both the subtraction and the comparator
blocks. Every 1/240 of a second, the circuit’s control functions are flipped to process the alternate
component of the multiplexed signal. The multiplexer switches signals, the two microprocessor
controlled gains are changed, if necessary, and a new digital code is sent to the DAC for use in
the subtraction circuit. After settling to it’s new value, the signal at the input of the comparator
is frozen by the sample and hold circuit. The DAC is now available to be used in the
digitization. At the next 1/240 second interval, all the control signals revert to the previous
values.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 2 - Theory of Operation
Revised 12/20/00
2-23
Digital Section
The digital section of the board performs two distinct functions: analog section control
and interface to communications ic’s.
This section is based on a 63C09E microprocessor. The analog section is accessed by
writing data into the control registers. Address decoding for generating control register
strobes CTRL-REG0*, CTRL-REG1*, and CTRL-REG2* is done by an EPLD address
decoder. The same address decoder is also responsible for monitoring status lines COMP*
and SAT*. THE 63C09E can observe the status of these lines by reading RD0 from the
assigned memory location (See Table XIV).
A watchdog timer chip provides RST and RST* signals to initialize the processor, the
three EPLD’s and the two communications ICs. This watchdog is activated by any of a
number of sources: 1) a dip in the +5 volt logic supply, 2) a reset from the Accutorr Plus
with SpO2 host processor board on HSTRST*, or 3) lack of a strobe from a software control
loop on DOG-STR*. A 68C681 UART interface the processor to the host processor board.
Processor and communications shared memory consists of both static ram and flash ram.
Figure 2-7
SpO2
Block Diagram
2-24
Revised 12/20/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 2 - Theory of Operation
2.2.6 Main Power Supply
Power supply for Sealed Lead Acid Battery
The power supply is capable of operation between 85 and 264 Vac, 47 to 63 Hz sinewave
input source.
It is a fixed frequency, (62 Khz) flyback buck converter with a secondary buck and
flyback converters for the outputs. The bulk output of about 17 V is regulated via
opto-coupler feedback. The bulk supply has over voltage and over current protection.
The secondary battery connection is diode “or”-ed with the bulk supply in order to
provide operation without AC applied. The battery is charged via a four stage charger.
Battery Charger for Sealed Lead Acid Battaery
The battery charger provides four levels of charge stages as well as over current and over
voltage protection. The circuit is based on a single chip controller, the Unitrode
UC3906, and external programming components. In this implementation, the circuit
detects the presence and voltage of the battery and provides a very low current source to
determine the state of the battery. If the battery voltage begins to rise, at a preset
threshold, the circuit switches to a heavy charge rate until and upper charge level is
attained. At this stage the circuit will switch into an overcharge or float charge mode to
insure a fully charged battery.
Power Supply for Lithium Ion battery
The power supply is capable of operation between 85 and 264 vac, 47 to 63 Hz
sinewave input source.
It is a fixed frequency, (62 Khz) flyback converter with individual secondary buck and
flyback converters for the outputs. The bulk output of about 14.5 V is regulated via
opto-coupler feedback. The bulk supply has over voltage and overload protection.
The output converters are diode “or” ed from either the bulk output of the battery
output in order to provide operation without AC power applied.
Battery Charger for Lithium Ion battery
The battery charger provides a two phase fast charge algorithm for Li-Ion batteries.
In phase one, the charger regulates constant current until the battery reaches the
maximum cell voltage (MCV). The charger then moves to phase two, and regulates
the battery voltage at MCV until the charging current falls to 14% of nominal.
The charger then terminates until the battery voltage falls below 95% of MCV.
The charger monitors battery condition, battery temperature, charging time, as
well as load on the outputs during battery charging operation. If the battery is
severely depleted, the charger will trickle charge at a rate of 1 Hz until the battery
is revived. The charger will suspend fast charge if the battery temperature is below
0 Deg C or above 45 Deg C. The charger will also suspend fast charge if the
battery has not reached voltage regulation within its allotted time. If the
Accutorr unit is operated during battery charger operation, then the maximum
fast charge current will be reduced.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 2 - Theory of Operation
Revised 12/20/00
2-25
2.2.7 Communication Board
The Accutorr Plus Communication module provides the communication signal interface
between the LED/CPU board, 0670-00-0650-01, and the external communication
interface connectors. The board supports the CIS/HI/DIAP interface via RS-232E, provides
a feed through path for the Datascope proprietary download connector, DC/DC converter
for the +12 Vdc @ 100 mA required for wireless telemetry controlled by the CPU and
includes the driver for an external isolation relay that is activated by Nurse Call (future
option).
The RS-232E interface, used for DIAP, is implemented using a Maxim, MAX239
Multi-Channel Transceiver (U2). This chip has a minimum ± 10 volt output signal level,
which provides a safe operating margin above the ± 5 volt minimum RS-232 operating signal
level. Communications is to support a 5 wire interface, 4 signals and a ground. The
signals are described below:
All RS-232 signal are ESD protected by a U3, an SM14M24C Transient Voltage
Suppressor array. The +12 Vdc power required by the MAX239 is supplied from the
on board DC/DC converter. In addition the MAX239 requires 5 Vdc for the internal
logic. This is supplied as an input to the communications module. The MAX239
receivers are controlled by logic signal CSTAT*. Logic 0 enables the receivers, otherwise they are tri-stated.
The RS-232 signals appear on connector J2, a dual row 5 pin header which will have
a mating 10 pin pendant ribbon cable attached. The other end of the ribbon cable
assembly is a 9 pin panel mount `D’ connector. Included on this connector are pins for
the future Nurse Call option. See chart for pinout.
The Accutorr Plus software is upgradable via a three wire download communications
interface. The required drivers are located on the LED/CPU board and only a signal path
is provided to the external interface connector. ESD protection for the signal lines is
provided by part of U3. Communications is to support a 3 wire interface, 2 signals and
a ground. The signals are Tip being transmit, Ring is receive and shield is ground.
The on board DC/DC convertor provides +12VDC power required for wireless telemetry
that will be a future feature available for Accutorr Plus as well as some local circuitry.
The DC/DC converter is implemented using a Maxim MAX1771 DC/DC controller used
in the Buck/Boost configuration. The supply is designed to deliver 12 Vdc @ 100 mA
minimum. When the SHDN pin (U1-4) is high the MAX1771 enters the shutdown
mode and its output is approximately zero volts. The shutdown mode is controlled by
the state of either of two logic signals NCALL* or CSTAT*. If either of the signals is
logic 0, the DC/DC converter will operate normally.
2-26
Revised 12/20/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 2 - Theory of Operation
VBULK
CSTAT*
12VDC
DC/DC
CONVERTER
NCALL*
(-01)
TD
TXD
RTS
RTS*
RS232
XCEIVER
RD
CTS*
RXD
CTS
NCALL
NCALL*
CSTAT*
PROTECTION
ARRAY
Figure 2-8
(-02)
TXD
TD
RD
RS485
XCEIVER
Communication Board
Block Diagram
RXD
The pin assignments for the 9 pin `D’ connector are as follows:
PIN
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
INPUT/OUTPUT
Output
Input
Output
Output
Output
Output
Input
Output
Output
DESCRIPTION
12VDC @ 100mA
RS-232
RS-232
± 10 Vdc min.
Ground
Ground
RS-232
RS-232
Ground
NAME
TR_PWR
EXT_RXD
EXT_TXD
Nurse_call
DGND
DGND
EXT_RTS
EXT_CTS
DGND
For Standard DIAP connection use pins 2,3,5,7&8 for 5 wire communication and use
pins 2,3&5 for 3 wire communication. For connection to a PC the cabling must be Null
Modem or:
Signal
TXD
RXD
Ground
RTS
CTS
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 2 - Theory of Operation
Accutorr Plus Pin
3
2
5
7
8
PC pin
2
3
5
8
7
Revised 12/20/00
2-27
2.2.8 LCD Inverter Module - 0670-00-0649
This describes the circuit that will provide the 90 VAC required for the LCD Module
back lite exitation.
DC to AC Inverter
The system +12V signal is fed into the module on J2-1. This signal is then fed to J1-1.
The inverter is powered by +12SW (12.5 volt nominal) from J1-2.
Once powered, the inverter is designed to provide the AC waveform required by the
backlight over the cabinet temperature range and +12V tolerance. The output AC waveform is 90 Vrms minimum voltage. The AC frequency is to be between 360Hz and
440Hz. C1 and C2 provide filtering of the inverter DC input.
Current Switch
The Q1 gate is connected to J2-3, ELOFF*. This control signal is pulled low by R1
which maintains Q1 in the off state if J2-3 is floating. Since Q1 passes the inverter
return current to the ground signal PGND on J2-2, Q1 must be on to enable the
inverter. The host can turn on Q1 and enable the T1 inverter by driving ELOFF* high.
D1 filters switching transients on +12SW when Q1 is turned on and off.
J1
ELPOWER
FILTER
DC/AC
INVERTER
GND
T1
+12V
J2
ELOFF*
GND
GND
FILTER
GND
CONTROL
FET SWITCH
GND
LCD CONNECTOR
POWER SUPPLY
CONNECTOR
Figure 2-9
LCD Inverter Module
Block Diagram
2-28
Revised 12/20/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 2 - Theory of Operation
2.2.9 Nellcor® MP 304 SpO2 Circuit Board Theory of Operation
The MP 304 is a complete SpO2 detection and determination circuit, proprietary of
Nellcor® Puritan Bennett.
The MP 304 is centralized around a Motorola MC68HC16 micro processor (U-4), driven
by a 32.76 Khz. Oscillator. (Y-2) The processor is supported by a 32K x 8 static RAM
(U-3) and a SpO2 program boot EPROM (U-6).
Patient information is initially processed in a patented ASIC (U-1) (Application Specific
Integrated Circuit). Clock pulses are provided by Y-1, a 10 MHZ oscillator. The resulting
analog data is then routed into separate Red and Infra Red ADC’s (Analog to Digital
Converters) (U-5 and U-7) The resulting digital data is clocked into the microprocessor
and is transmitted serially to the Nellcor® Interface Board (0670-00-0675) for further
processing and display.
U-3
Static
RAM
32x8
DATA BUS
U-6
EPROM
ADDRESS BUS
SERIAL
DATA
RED_ADC
P-1
U-1
ASIC
A / D_ CLOCK
U-5
ADC
NELLCOR
Sensor
Input
IR_ADC
U-4
MC68HC16
U-7
ADC
RX
TX
RST*
Y-1
10 Mhz
Connector to
NELLCOR Interface
Board
Y-2
32.768 Khz
NELLCOR MP304
Block Diagram
0671-00-0162
Figure 2-10
Nellcor MP304
Block Diagram
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 2 - Theory of Operation
Revised 12/20/00
2-29
2.2.10
NellcorÒ Interface Board Theory of Operation
The Datascope to Nellcor® interface circuit board establishes bi lateral communication
and control of the Nellcor® Oximeter circuit board.
The circuit board consists of a power supply section that converts +5 VDC into the logic
and analog supplies required by the oximeter, and optically isolated logic control for the
processing circuits of the oximeter. The optically isolated up converter U1 convert the
+5 VDC from the main power supply, into an input voltage for U6, of about 5 VDC.
The precision down converter, U6, steps down and regulates the +5 VDC voltage for the
digital sections of the oximeter circuit.
The optically isolated up converter U2 convert the +5 VDC to a bi polar +9 and -9 VDC
input for U4 and U5, then regulated to +5 and -5 VDC.
The logic control section, consisting of U1, U2 and U3, provide the buffer and isolation
functions from the main CPU circuit to the Nellcor® oximeter section.
Figur2-11
Datascope Interface
Circuit to Nellcor
MP304 Oximeter
2-30
Revised 12/20/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 2 - Theory of Operation
2.2.11 Masimo SETÒ Technology
Masimo SETâ Technology, combines advances in fundamental sensor technology, digital
signal processing, an easily portable platform and a low noise hardware platform
incorporating multiple wavelengths applicable to many physiological parameters.
Masimo’s SETâ Technology is composed of three components; (1) new signal processing
apparatus, (2) a new method for invivo measurement, and (3) new sensor technologies.
The main benefit of Masimo’s technology is the effective cancellation of unpredictable
“in-band noise” (noise which is in the same frequency, phase and/or amplitude space as
the desired signal).
Conventional fixed filters, whether analog or digital form, have been designed to pass
certain frequencies while rejecting others. For example, a bandpass filter with a lower
cut-off frequency of 1hz and an upper cut-off frequency of 10Hz will pass all frequencies
between 1hz and 10Hz and reject frequencies below 1hz and above 10Hz. Therefore, any
“noise” that has a frequency outside the pass band is rejected and not considered
(i.e. 120Hz due to room light and 60Hz noise from electrical lines). However, if noise
exists between the pass band of 1hz and 10Hz it will enter the system with the desired
signal and corrupt the measurement (i.e. patient motion at 2Hz). Fixed filters will always
have this limitation.
Masimo has overcome these problems by developing a novel technique to accurately
determine the noise reference (patents issued and pending); thus, making adaptive filters
work in real-time even when applied to medical monitoring of widely variable and
unpredictable patients. With this new technique, Masimo is able to solve the perennial
problem of motion artifact in pulse oximetry.
Masimo licenses this technology to Datascope. Further technical information is available
from MasimoÒ on the Internet at www.Masimo.com.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 2 - Theory of Operation
Revised 12/20/00
2-31
2.2.12
Masimo Interface Board Theory of Operation
Introduction
The Accutorr Plus Masimo interface board (P/N: 0670-00-0716) provides an isolated
data and power interface between the Accutorr Plus and the MasimoÒ MP-3 Pulse
Oximetry Module.
The patient isolation requirement for the Masimo section is 1500VAC, less than or equal
to 1mA leakage current, from input connectors J1 and J4-all terminals to J2-all terminals.
The isolated DC/DC converter, T1, supplies the regulated+5DIG as required by the
MasimoÒ MS-3 Pulse Oximetry Module. The digital 5V is then utilized to generate the
analog "15V used by the MS-3. The optocouplers (U1 and U2) isolate the signals used
for bidirectional serial communication with the MasimoÒ MS-3 Pulse Oximetry Module.
Control signal, SpO2_COMM at J4 will allow the Accutorr Plus software to interrupt
the serial transmission for future options. Future interface to the Display Controller
board (at J3) will provide isolated "9volts to the Front End
Theory of Operation
An overall block diagram of the interface board is shown in Figure 1 below. All data and
control lines interfaced to the SpO2 Module are opto isolated. Power to the SpO2
Module is isolated by a DC/DC converter with the input coming directly from the
CPU/LED Module.
Figure 2-12
2-32
Revised 12/20/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 2 - Theory of Operation
Detailed Description
It would be helpful to have a schematic (0387-00-0716) while reading the following
circuit descriptions.
Power
The power for the interface board is supplied by the system +5V. It is used for the
pull-up resistors (R1, R2 and R6) on the serial and control lines as well as the LED drive
resistors (R3 and R4) on optocoupler U1. It is also the input to isolation converters T1
and T2. In addition, the system +5V is the supply voltage for optocoupler U2 and the
logic gates in U3.
T1 converts the unisolated system +5V into an isolated and regulated source, +5DIG, for
many uses. The converter provides suitable isolation to the specified patient limit of
1500VAC. The majority of the current from +5DIG is delivered to the MS-3 board. It
also acts as the supply voltage for optocoupler U1 and the ESD protection array, U5. In
addition, the digital voltage supplies the LED drive resistor (R5) on optocoupler U2.
The second largest usage for the +5DIG is as an input for the LT1373. The LT1373 is a
high frequency current mode switching regulator running at approximately 250kHz. In
this design, it is configured as an extremely efficient dual flyback converter. It will
convert a single input voltage ranging from 2.7 to 25 volts into a positive and negative
output. This design utilizes the feedback to provide +/-15VAN to the MS-3 board. The
power transistor “switch” integral to the LT1373 alternately charges and discharges the
output capacitor C16. C12 and C13 provide the hold-up time for the output voltages.
L2-C14 and L3-C15 are additional low pass filters for the analog voltages.
Converter T2 generates an unregulated +/-9V (used for the front end). Schottky diodes
CR1 and CR2 provide reverse polarity protection for T2. C10 and C11 filter the isolated
+/-9V in order to reduce the ripple on each supply.
Caps C17 and C19 on the input of the two DC/DC converters are necessary to reduce the
ripple reflected back on to the system +5V. This noise is generated due to the transient
nature of the MS-3 loading.
Communication
The interface signals to and from the MS-3 are isolated (2500VAC) by two optocouplers,
U1 and U2. The optocouplers include integrated Schmitt triggers at the outputs. This
provides logic compatible waveforms without the need for external pull-up resistors.
NANDs are used in the transmission lines to provide the necessary inversions for proper
signal polarity and to force the optocouplers normally off. The low duty cycle of the
signals also holds the power requirements to reasonable levels.
Communications with the SpO2 Module take place by a CMOS level asynchronous serial
link from J1. The parameters are 8 data bits, no parity, one stop bit, with the data
having “true” polarity. The baud rate is fixed at 9600 bps.
Display Controller Connections
A four pin right angled connector (J4) is available to interface with the future Display
Controller board. The serial information received (TX and RX) will be used to generate
a pleth waveform. The control signal (SpO2_COMM*) will be an active low signal used
to enable a download to this future board.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 2 - Theory of Operation
Revised 12/20/00
2-33
Front End Connections
The front end section of the future Display Controller board will be provided with an
unregulated +9V and –9V. These supplies will be able to sustain maximum loads of
56mA each (refer to the manufacturers data sheet for T2, CDI 109D5VFS).
2.2.13
Tone Processor Board Theory of Operation
The Accutorr Plus Tone-Processor module drives all alarms and advisory tones, generated
by the LED/CPU module, to the speaker. The signal is passed through a DAC
(Digital-to-Analog-Converter), which controls the rise and decay of the output tone to
comply with EN-475 specification
Figure 2-13
Tone-Processor Module
Functional Block
Diagram
Device U1 is an Atmel ATmega103, 8-bit AVR microcontroller. The ATmega103 is a
low-power CMOS microcontroller based on the AVR RISC architecture. Its throughput
approaches one MIPS per MHz allowing optimization of power consumption versus
processing speed.
U2 is a dual 8-bit DAC that interfaces to the Microcontroller. It controls the tone up/down
ramping under the command of the Microcontroller, by controlling the attenuation to its input
signal. The device’s chip-select and write-enable pulses are provided by the Microcontroller.
Proper hardware operation places specific requirements on the module’s software. Although
specific implementation details fall beyond the scope this document, the following is an
overview of the major tasks to be performed by the software.
The Microcontroller would normally be placed in a sleep state, after initialization, in the
absence of a tone signal in order to conserve power. Upon the presence of an advisory tone
or an alarm an interrupt is generated, which wakes up the device. The amplitude and
frequency of the incoming signal is analyzed then, a replica of the input signal is generated,
after approximately 25ms delay, and presented to the DAC. The tone ramp-up sequence
is accomplished with dedicated I/O ports, which drives write commands and control
bytes with an increasing count and to the DAC, triggered by the period of the input
tone. This would result in an audible tone with rising amplitude. Upon detection of the
end of the tone burst, the ramp-down sequence is entered, similar in nature to the
ramp-up sequence.
2-34
Added 12/20/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 2 - Theory of Operation
3.0 SPECIFICATIONS
CONTENTS OF THIS CHAPTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Page
3.1 Performance Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1
3.2 Safety Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6
3.3 Physical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7
3.4 Environmental Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7
3.5 Electrical Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7
3.6 Agency Compliance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8
3.7 Electromagnetic Compatibility. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8
3.1 PERFORMANCE SPECIFICATIONS
Systolic Pressure Readout
Number of Digits:
3
Accuracy*:
Mean error less than ± 5 mmHg, Standard deviation
less than ± 8 mmHg.
Range:
Adult Mode: 55 to 260 mmHg
Pediatric Mode: 55 to 160 mmHg
Neonatal Mode: 45to 120 mmHg
Diastolic Pressure Readout
Number of Digits:
3
Accuracy*:
Mean error less than ± 5 mmHg, Standard deviation
less than ± 8 mmHg.
Range:
Adult Mode: 30 to 200 mmHg
Pediatric Mode: 30 to 150 mmHg
Neonatal Mode: 25 to 100 mmHg
*Tested per ANSI/AAMI SP10-1992 methods.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 3 - Specifications
Revised 12/20/00
3-1
NIBP Measurement Cycle Time
Less than 30 seconds average at 80 BPM with 180mmHg pump up pressure, without
retries, motion artifact or arrhythmia with standard adult cuff on a healthy individual.
Cycle time is affected by arm size and wrapping technique.
Pulse Rate
Range:
35-245 BPM for Adult and Pediatric
70-245 BPM for Neonate
Display Resolution:
1 BPM
Accuracy:
± 3 BPM or ± 3%, whichever is greater
Maximum Cuff Pressure
Two means of limiting cuff pressure are provided; a hardware over pressure monitor which
limits the pressure to 330mmHg for Adults, 220mmHg for Pediatrics and 165mmHg
for Neonates. A software overpressure monitor which vents if the pressure exceeds
300mmHg for Adults and 200mmHg for Pediatrics. If the hardware over pressure circuit
is tripped in normal operation then the unit must be turned off and back on to reset the
system.
Inflation Source
This inflation source is capable of supplying sufficient air to bring a volume of 700cc’s
to a pressure of 300 mmHg in no more than 35 seconds. If the cuff is not inflated to
the desired pressure within 60 seconds then the cuff is vented and a retry cycle is initiated.
Leak Rate
With the bleed valve closed, the maximum pressure drop shall be 10 mmHg in 90
seconds measured with a 700cc volume at a differential pressure of 250 mmHg.
Cuff Vent Rate
When the unit is vented, a volume of at least 700 cc’s is reduced from a pressure of 250
mmHg to a pressure of 20 mmHg in a maximum of 14 seconds.
3-2
Revised 06/25/99
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 3 - Specifications
Temperature (Predictive)
Range:
90-110° F, 32-43° C
Display Resolution:
0.1° F, 0.1° C
Accuracy:
Meets ASTM E1112-86 for accuracy.
Datascope SpO 2
Range:
40-100% SpO2
Display Resolution:
1% SpO2
Display Update:
Less than 4 seconds
Calibration:
Factory Calibrated to Functional Saturation
Accuracy - Datascope:
± 2% from 70 - 100% SpO2
± 4% from 60 - 69% SpO2
unspecified from 40-59% SpO2
Pulse Rate Range
Pulse Rate Accuracy
30 to 250 BPM
"3 BPM or 3% of the reading, whichever is greater.
Nellcor® SpO2
Range:
40-100% SpO2
Display Resolution:
1% SpO2
Display Update:
Less than 4 seconds
Calibration:
Automatic
Accuracy - Nellcor®:
± 2 digits from 70 - 100% SpO2 - Adult
± 3 digits from 70 - 100% SpO2 - Neonates
unspecified from 40-69% SpO2
Pulse Rate Range
Pulse Rate Accuracy
21 to 249 BPM
"3 BPM.
Neonatal accuracy specifications are based upon testing the N-3000 and N-25 neonatal
sensors on healthy adult volunteers in induced hypoxia studies, in the range of 70-100%
SpO2. The specified accuracy also takes into account published literature which predicts
that there may be a small difference in % SpO2 reported by the oximeter when measurements from adult and fetal blood with 100% fetal hemoglobin are compared. Fetal
hemoglobin is present in concentrations varying from 10% to 90% in neonatal blood,
and this percentage declines over time. As the percentage of fetal hemoglobin in neonatal
blood declines, the theoretical effect on accuracy due to this source is reduced".
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 3 - Specifications
Revised 02/15/00
3-3
Masimo® SpO2
Range:
Display Resolution:
Display Update:
Calibration:
40-100% SpO2
1% SpO2
Less than 4 seconds
Automatic
SpO2 Accuracy
Saturation during
No Motion Conditions1:
Adults:
70% to 100% ± 2 digits
Neonates:
70% to 100% ± 3 digits
40 to 69% SpO2 unspecified.
SpO2 Accuracy
Saturation during
Motion Conditions:2
Adults:
70% to 100% ± 3 digits
Neonates:
70% to 100% ± 4 digits
Pulse Rate Range:
Pulse Rate Accuracy:
26 to 239 BPM
"3 BPM
1
The Masimo MS-3 pulse oximeter with LNOP Adt sensors have been validated for
no motion accuracy in human blood studies on healthy adult volunteers in induced
hypoxia studies in the range of 70% to 100% SpO2 against a laboratory co-oximeter
and ECG monitor. This variation equals plus or minus one standard deviation.
Plus or minus one standard deviation encompasses 68% of the population.
2
The Masimo MS-3 pulse oximeter with LNOP Adt sensors has been validated
for motion accuracy in human blood studies on healthy adult volunteers in
induced hypoxia studies while performing rubbing and tapping motions at 2 to 4
Hz. At an amplitude of 1 to 2 cm and non-repetitive motion between 1 to 5 Hz.
At an amplitude of 2 to 3 cm in induced hypoxia studies in the range of 70% to
100% SpO2 against a laboratory co-oximeter and ECG monitor. This variation
equals plus or minus one standard deviation. Plus or minus one standard
deviation encompasses 68% of the population.
3-4
Revised 06/19/01
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 3 - Specifications
Battery
Battery Type:
Sealed Lead Acid
Lithium-ion
Number of Batteries:
1
1
Battery Voltage:
12 VDC nominal
10.8 VDC nominal
Battery Capacity:
2.3 Amp-Hour
3.6 Amp-Hour
Battery Run Times
from full charge
with a new battery at
25° C with 1 NIBP
measurement every 5
minutes and recorder
in use.
Accutorr Plus NIBP
– 5 Hour
Accutorr Plus NIBP
with Trend Screen
– 3 Hours
Accutorr Plus NIBP – 8 Hours
Accutorr Plus NIBP with with
Trend Screen – 8 Hours
Accutorr Plus NIBP with
Trend Screen and SpO2:
Datascope – 1.5 Hours
Nellcor – 2 Hours
Masimo – 2 Hours
Accutorr Plus NIBP with
Trend Screen and SpO2:
Datascope – 3.5 Hours
Nellcor – 4.5 Hours
Masimo – 4.5 Hours
Recharge Time:
8 hours max.,
in standby only
2 hours max., in standby only
Cyclic Service Life:
150 cycles, 100% to
20% of capacity
400 cycles, 100% to
40% of capacity
500 cycles, 100% to 30% of capacity
1000 cycles, 100% to 50% of capacity
Real Time Clock
Resolution:
1 minute
Accuracy:
± 1 minute/week
Display Format:
24 hours
Power:
The real time clock maintains the time and date when the
instrument is On or in the Standby mode, connected to AC
mains or running from internal battery for at least ten years
from original assembly. The real time clock will maintain time
and date even if the instrument’s main battery is disconnected.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 3 - Specifications
Revised 12/20/00
3-5
3.2 Safety Characteristics
Risk (Leakage) Currents
Enclosure Risk Current
(leakage):
Less than or equal to 100uA in normal operating
conditions.
Less than or equal to 300 uA in any single fault condition .
Patient Source Current:
Less than or equal to 10uA in normal operating
conditions.
Less than or equal to 50uA in any single fault condition.
Patient Sink Current:
Less than or equal to 50uA.
Dielectric Withstand
2500V RMS at 50 or 60 Hz for 1 minute from any patient lead or combination of
patient leads to the chassis.
1500V RMS at 50 or 60 Hz for 1 minute AC mains hot or neutral to the chassis.
Ground Resistance
Ground resistance less than or equal to 0.1 ohm from the AC mains power inlet
module’s ground contact pin to any exposed metal part which may become energized
when measured per UL-544 and IEC 601-1. A ground resistance of up to 0.2 ohm is
allowed when measured from the U blade of the supplied AC line cord to any
exposed metal part which may become energized.
Type of Protection Against Electric Shock
Class 1 with internal electric power source. Where the integrity of the external
protective earth (ground) in the installation or it’s conductors is in doubt, the
equipment shall be operated from it’s internal electric power source.
Degree of Protection Against Electric Shock
Monitor – Type B applied part.
NIBP – Type BF defibrillation protected applied part.
SpO2 – Type BF defibrillation protected applied part.
Protection Against Hazards of Explosion
Not protected (ordinary).
Protection Against Ingress of Liquids
Not protected (ordinary).
3-6
Revised 12/20/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 3 - Specifications
3.3 Physical Characteristics
Size (maximum):
Main Unit:
19 cm(W) x 26.93 cm(H) x 20.83 cm (D)
7.5" (W) x 10.6" (H) x 8.2" (D)
Recorder Module:
5.33 cm(W) x 23 cm(H) x 11 cm (D)
2.1" (W) x 9" (H) x 4.25" (D)
Predictive Module:
5.7 cm(W) x 15.9 cm(H) x 11.8 cm (D)
2.25" (W) x 6.25" (H) x 4.63" (D)
Weight:
<4.95 kg (11 pounds), depending on configuration.
3.4 Environmental Characteristics
Operating Temperature:
Accutorr Plus with or
without Recorder:
10° C to 40° C, (50° F to 104° F)
Infrared Therrmometer
Module:
18° C to 40° C, (65° F to 104° F
Predictive Thermometer
Module:
10° C to 32° C, (50° F to 90° F)
Operating Humidity:
15 to 90% max, non-condensing.
Shock and Vibration:
Meets IEC 68-2-27, IEC 68-2-37.
Shipping:
Meets ISTA Test Procedure 1A (less than 100 lbs.)
Storage Temperature:
-15° C to +40° C, +5° F to 104° F
Storage Humidity:
10 to 95%, non-condensing.
Operating Altitude:
1013 hPa to 782 hPa (0 to 7,000 ft.). for units with an LCD
1013 hPa to 697 hPa (0 to 10,000 ft.) for units
without an LCD
3.5 Electrical Ratings
Voltage:
100 - 120 / 220 - 240 VAC
Current:
0.6 / 0.3 A
Frequency:
60 / 50 Hz
Power Consumption:
40 W, maximum
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 3 - Specifications
Revised 12/20/00
3-7
4.0 REPAIR INFORMATION
CONTENTS OF THIS CHAPTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Page
4.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1
4.2 Safety Precautions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2
4.3 General Troubleshooting Guidelines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2
4.4 Test Equipment Required . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3
4.5 Troubleshooting (Problem Isolation) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4
4.6 Disassembly Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9
4.1 INTRODUCTION
This chapter of the Service Manual provides the technical information necessary to
resolve most instrument malfunctions. Important prerequisites for effective
troubleshooting are a thorough understanding of the instrument functions, and specification,
as well as an understanding of the theory of operation. Refer to Chapters 1, 2, and 3 of
this manual for detailed information.
Functional over views of the major circuit blocks are provided in the Theory of Operation,
Chapter 2, of this manual, for those technically qualified who may prefer to isolate
problems to a sub-circuit or component level. Component level repair activity is not
always possible. Isolation of defective components is frequently impossible without the
functional emulation of operating software. The equipment and processes required are
not cost effective on a single unit basis.
This procedure is for the use of qualified technical personnel only. Datascope Corp. offers
a comprehensive selection of Technical Training Seminars for this and other products.
Contact the Registrar, Technical Support Department or your regional sales or service
representative for course offerings and dates.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 4 - Repair Information
Revised 02/15/00
4-1
4.2 SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
There are areas where improper repair techniques will cause further damage. When the
instrument covers are removed, observe the following precautions and guidelines.
1. Power line voltages will be exposed; identify hazard points and avoid direct contact.
2. Battery terminals are accessible; do not short to each other or the positive terminal to
ground circuits, as the capacity of the battery is sufficient to create an over heating
safety hazard.
3. Fuses must not be by passed or replaced by different current, voltage or time delay
ratings.
4. The circuit boards contain static sensitive components; use proper static safeguard
techniques.
CAUTION: Li-lon batteries are intended for replacement by qualified service personnel only.
CAUTION: Li-lon batteries used in this device may present a risk of fire or chemical burn if
mistreated. Do not disassemble, heat above 100°C (212°F), or incinerate. Replace battery with
Datascope P/N: 0146-00-0069 only. Use of another battery may present a risk of fire or
explosion.
CAUTION: Dispose of used battery promptly. Keep away from children. Do not disassemble and
do not dispose of in fire.
4.3 GENERAL TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDELINES
This procedure does not cover all possible problems. The intent of troubleshooting is to
provide quick isolation and remedy of malfunctions and to return the instrument
promptly to safe patient care. A logical approach will quickly identify the problem and
suggest cost effective solutions.
Troubleshooting Tips
1. Isolate the cause of the problem to be either clinical, instrument or external.
If a clinical cause is suspected, take the physiological measurement by a manual method
or use an alternate measuring device. Check the physiological value against the instrument
specifications; if exceeds specification, continue with manual or alternate method.
If a problem with the instrument is suspected, first examine and / or replace patient
connected accessories. Check instrument set-up / configuration. Ensure the correct
battery charge profile is selected for the installed battery. If all set-ups are OK,
replace instrument with similar device.
If the environment is suspected, observe if the malfunction coincides with other
equipment cycling (especially high power motors, RF generators, etc...). Replace
problem instrument with an identical substitute. Place the problem instrument in a
low disturbance environment. If the problem persists in the low disturbance
environment, the instrument performance may be suspect. If the substitute instrument
exhibits similar poor performance in the original environment, the environmental
causes must be eliminated.
4-2
Revised 12/20/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 4 - Repair Information
2. Use the proper equipment. Special test equipment required for problem isolation and
resolution is listed in section 4.4. Similar devices may be used if they equal or exceed
performance standards of the equipment suggested.
PRECAUTION: This instrument utilizes multiple layer circuit boards and laser and
ultra sonic welded surface mounted components. Do not attempt to un-solder welded
components from the circuit board; the circuit board will be permanently damaged.
PRECAUTION: Soldering and solder removal equipment must be low voltage operated
and grounded to avoid static charge and stray current induced component damage.
Maximum wattage: 25 W.
3. Clean the repair area. After soldering operations, clean off the repaired area with ethyl
or methyl alcohol and a stiff hair brush. This will remove residual solder flux, making
the repaired area more visible for an inspection and returning the instrument to its
original, neat appearance. Removal of the flux will also facilitate making electrical
measurements in the affected area as the flux itself is not conductive.
Exchange Program
Datascope offers a comprehensive circuit board and electro-mechanical module exchange
program. The exchange circuits and modules are warranted, factory pre-tested and
calibrated. Final calibration of the exchange item is strongly suggested to match the new
part to the host system. See section 6.4 for details concerning the exchange program.
4.4 TEST EQUIPMENT REQUIRED
Equipment types other than these listed may be utilized if they equal or exceed the listed
equipment performance.
• Dynatech Nevada Non-invasive Blood Pressure Simulator (Cuff Link)
• Power Supply, Power-Mate, 3A 20V
• Fluke D.V.M, Model 8050A
• Digital Storage Scope, Tektronix, 2230 100 MHZ
• Stop Watch, Wilson LW#119
• SpO2 Simulator, Biotek Index, Smart SAT (All SpO2 versions);
N-1290 (Nellcor SpO2 Only)
• RS232 Test Connector (Pins 2 and 3 Shorted)
• 700cc Dummy Cuff, Datascope #0138-00-0001-01
• Chart Paper, Datascope #0683-00-0447-01
• Water Bath, Cole-Palmer model H-12-105-10
• Reference Quartz Thermometer, Hewlet-Packard model HP-2804A
with Temp. Probe HP-1811A
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 4 - Repair Information
Revised 12/20/00
4-3
4.5 TROUBLESHOOTING (PROBLEM ISOLATION)
This section has been divided into two major areas; clinical and technical. Clinical problems
can generally be resolved by the user. Technical problems may require resolution by a
qualified technical service person. The error code table below indicates Technical problems
with an asterisk (*). Error codes are displayed on the front panel LED’s of the Accutorr Plus.
TYPE
NIBP
TEMP
(PTM)
SpO2
CODE DESCRIPTION
8810 Retry - Unable to
Measure
8811 Retry - Pump
Higher
8812 Stop - Cuff
Overpressure
8813 Stop - Unable to
Measure
8830 Check Probe
8831 Replace Probe
8832 Battery Low
8850 No Sensor
8851 Sensor Off
8852
8853
8854
8855
8856
8857
8857
8857
8858
8858
8858
SYSTEM 984*
985*
986*
987*
Table 4-1
Error Codes
4-4
988*
990*
991*
995*
996*
Revised 02/15/00
REASON
Motion artifact, cycle time-out, weak pulsations or no pulsations.
A triple beep tone is generated.
Insufficient cuff pressure. A triple beep tone is generated.
Excessive cuff pressure detected by the software. A triple beep
tone is generated.
4 successive measurement attempts failed. A triple beep tone is
generated.
Tissue contact may have been lost.
Defective probe or connection.
The 9V battery needs replacement.
No sensor connected.
Sensor not on patient.
(Datascope and Masimo SpO2 only)
Interference
Interference on signal.
(Datascope and Masimo SpO2 only)
Pulse Search
Unit cannot find signal. (Nellcor SpO2 Module will report
“Pulse Search” -8853- when the sensor is not on the patient.)
Weak Pulse
Weak pulse detected.
(Datascope and Masimo SpO2 only)
No Pulse
No pulse detected. (Datascope SpO2 only)
Check Sensor
Sensor problem.
(Datascope and Masimo SpO2 only)
PR<30
Pulse rate is less than 30 bpm. (Datascope SpO2 only)
PR<21
Pulse rate is less than 21 bpm. (Nellcor SpO2 only)
PR<26
Pulse rate is less than 26 bpm. (Masimo SpO2 only)
PR>249
Pulse rate is greater than 249 bpm. (Nellcor SpO2 only)
PR>239
Pulse rate is greater than 239 bpm. (Masimo SpO2 only)
PR>250
Pulse rate is greater than 250 bpm. (Datascope SpO2 only)
NIBP Hardware Failure NIBP A/D failure detected.
NIBP Overpressure
The overpressure circuit is not set to the current patient size.
Circuit not
Programmed
NIBP Overpressure
The two pressure transducers are not tracking each other.
Circuit not Tracking
Stop - Hardware
Excessive cuff pressure detected by hardware over-pressure
Overpressure
sensor. A triple beep tone is generated.
TEMP Bad Calibration Thermometer needs calibration.
TEMP Illegal Mode
Thermometer switch is set wrong.
TEMP Module Failed Thermometer internal failure.
SpO2 fails calibration check.
SpO2 Uncalibrated
SpO2 Failure
SpO2 failed self-test.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 4 - Repair Information
4.5.1 Isolating the Problem, System Level
1. Determine if the problem is in the main NIBP unit or one of the add on accessories.
2. If the problem is in the accessory, replace the 9 Volt battery in the temperature module,
and check the recorder unit for correct paper, correct installation and paper jams.
3. If the problem is in the main NIBP and/or SpO2 section, rule out these simple
problems first:
If AC power is available, then the green LED adjacent to the front panel On/Off keys
should be illuminated. If not, connect the power cord to live power outlet. If green
LED fails to illuminate, there is a probable power supply malfunction.
Check the battery operation LED. Steady ON indicates battery operation. A flashing
LED indicates a near depleted battery. If the green LED is NOT On, then the battery
or power supply/charger may be suspect.
Confirm correct operating parameters selection, i.e., correct patient size selection,
(Adult, Neonate, Ped.) and NIBP cuffs to match. In units with SpO2, verify that a
sensor is connected to the unit and it is of the proper type/size. Verify the proper
battery charge profile is selected for the installed battery.
4.5.2 Isolating the Problem within the Main Unit
Problems within the main NIBP and/or SpO2 unit are categorized broadly into power
supply problems and NIBP and/or SpO2 detection and display. For a monitor that will
not even turn on, proceed to Power Supply and Battery Tests, otherwise skip to
Diagnostics Test and beyond.
1. Power Supply and Battery test: The main power supply output voltages should be
verified under normal instrument loads. Voltages are shown on the System Block
diagram, which is located in chapter 2 of this manual. Below are the tolerances for the
voltages shown:
5V = 4.9 - 5.1
12.5V = 12 - 13
15V = 14.5 - 15.5
2. Perform Diagnostics Test 01 through 12 . Repair or replace circuits or components
that fail to pass the Diagnostic Test.
3. Trend circuits test: Obtain a minimum of five NIBP measurements and simultaneous
SpO2 and Temperature readings if the Accutorr has those options. Confirm Trend
storage function as explained in sections 1.3.6, To View and Deleted Stored Data
(Trend Mode) and 1.3.12, Recorder.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 4 - Repair Information
Revised 12/20/00
4-5
4.5.3 Isolating the Problems with Optional Accessory Modules:
1. Predictive Temperature Module Test: Obtain one or more temperature readings from the
optional temperature modules. They will be displayed in the temperature display window. If
the readings are not displayed, replace the temperature probe first, then the complete module.
2. Infrared (Accutemp I.R.) temperature module test: The following paragraphs will assist
you to separate those clinical issues that can result in inaccurate or inconsistent readings,
as well as instrument malfunctions.
Since there are no user serviceable components (except 9V battery) inside the
Accutemp I.R. all service requests should be directed to the factory.
3. Recorder Module Test: Obtain a print out of stored data, or perform diagnostics test (#4)
to verify printer integrity. Substitute printer with a know good device to confirm diagnosis.
4.5.4 Clinical Issues
4.5.4.1 Multiple Temperature Measurements
The AccuTemp employs an easy and quick method to taking temperature measurements.
Because of this it is tempting to take immediate, repetive measurements. However,
taking immediate repetitive measurements in the same ear, may result in a decrease in
temperature. This is because the probe of an ear thermometer is cooler than the ear canal
and will draw the heat from the ear canal, cooling the canal slightly. Waiting a few
minutes before taking another temperature in the same ear will give the ear canal time to
recover, and the readings should be consistent with the initial measurement.
4.5.4.2
How the AccuTemp Measures Arterial Temperature (adults/pediatrics)
The AccuTemp is a self-calibrating infrared ear thermometer that accurately measures the infrared
heat energy radiating from the ear canal opening. The AccuTemp determines the highest
temperature in the ear canal opening, measures the ambient temperature, and then calculates
arterial (core) temperature through its patented heat balance system. This measurement will respond
instantly to changes in arterial temperature without the delays and artifacts inherent in oral and
rectal methods, providing the means to identify a fever faster and more reliably than other methods.
Temperature gradients in the ear canal vary with the amount of environmental exposure,
perfusion patterns, ambient temperature, etc. The least variable and therefore most accurate is
the small deep area of warmest, but still visible tissue. A conventional ear thermometer takes many
readings of the same large area, which includes the high gradient distal ear tissue, resulting in
low, non-reproducible, and inaccurate temperature readings. The AccuTemp utilizes a narrow
field-of-view and scanning capability to search the ear for the small deep area of warmest tissue
required for heat balance calculation to ensure highly accurate and reproducible arterial temperatures.
The temperature measurement will remain on the display for a minimum of 55 and a
maximum of 65 seconds after the Start button is released. If using the AccuTemp with
and Accutorr Plus, the temperature measurement can be transferred from the AccuTemp
to the Accutorr Plus for display and entry in to the trend database, by placing the
AccuTemp in its holder within the 60 seconds after releasing the Start button. A beep
tone is sounded from the Accutorr Plus once the temperature measurement information
4-6
Added 6/25/99
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 4 - Repair Information
has been received by the Accutorr Plus. NOTE: Do not change Room Number and /or
Bed Letter on the Accutorr Plus during the transmission of temperature data.
The AccuTemp can be used to take temperature measurements for up to 128 power
cycles without having to be put back into its holder. After 128 power cycles, the
AccuTemp must be put back into the holder to be reset. When the 129th power cycle is
reached and the Start button is pressed, 4 L’s are displayed, indicating that the
AccuTemp is locked and must be returned to its holder.
NOTE: The AccuTemp thermometer should be at room temperature when it is used. If
it has been in a very warm or very cold environment it may need time for the thermometer
temperature to equalize to ambient temperature.
4.5.4.3
Troubleshooting
The following table provides suggestions to resolve problems when taking temperature
measurements:
Symptom
Various readings when
taking measurements in
the same location, ear
or axilla.
Various readings when
taking measurements
in opposite ears.
No measurement or
inaccurate measurements.
AccuTemp Error
AccuTemp double beeps and
displays “——” while holding
the Start button. The AccuTemp
then powers down.
AccuTemp double beeps
while holding the Start button
AccuTemp displays “E-O0"or ”E-o1"
while holding the Start button.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 4 - Repair Information
Suggestion
Quick repetitive measurements in the same location can
result in a decrease in temperature. This can occur
because the optical head of AccuTemp may slightly cool
the area. Wait a few minutes for the temperature of the
area to equilibrate. Replace cover and clean lens. See
section 3.3, Maintenance, for details on lens cleaning.
The patient may by lying down on one ear. The
measurement of the ear that was down may be a higher
temperature. Wait a few minutes for the temperature of
the ear canal to equilibrate. This is also a factor if the
area has been covered for any reason, i.e., hat, blanket,
bandage, telephone, etc.
This can be caused by technique errors:
-Not keeping the button pressed throughout the
measurement.
-Not scanning side-to-side (adults and pediatrics).
-Twisting or rotating the probe instead of scanning
side-to side.
-Not changing the protective optical film cover with
each reading. (Even on the same patient.)
-Debris on the lens.
-Not covering the opening of the ear canal.
-Presence of a visible wax plug, or dense hair blocking
the view into the ear canal.
-This can also be caused by low battery voltage.
Reason
Battery voltage < 5.7 VDC. Battery requires
replacement.
Low battery condition. Battery voltage is between 6.2
and 5.7 VDC.
Return AccuTemp for service.
Added 6/25/99
4-7
4.5.4.4 Maintenance
The AccuTemp can be wiped down with any hospital approved disinfectant, including
bleach. With normal use, the only maintenance required is to keep the lens on the end of
the probe clean. The lens is made of polycarbonate. Dirt, greasy films or moisture on the
lens will interfere with the passage of infrared heat and affect the accuracy of the
measurement. If necessary, clean the lens with a cotton swab dipped in alcohol. Periodic
cleaning is recommended. To keep the lens clean when not is use, store the AccuTemp
with an optical film cover in place.
4-8
Added 6/25/99
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 4 - Repair Information
4.6 DISASSEMBLY INSTRUCTIONS
PRECAUTION: THE INSIDE OF THIS INSTRUMENT CONTAINS STATIC
SENSITIVE COMPONENTS. Use correct static protection safeguards.
NOTE: The numbers in parentheses ( ) refer to the isometric drawings (page 6-4). Before
disassembling the unit, perform the following:
1. Power down the Accutorr Plus and remove the AC power cable.
2. Remove all cables and hoses from the front and rear of the instrument.
3. Remove temperature measuring module and recorder module, if equipped.
4.6.1 Removal of the Rear Housing (27)
1. Place the Accutorr Plus with the display side down, onto a protective surface.
NOTE: Special care should be taken to insure that the front panel and glare screen
are not scratched.
2. Remove the 4 screws from the corners of the back housing recess and the two screws
in the center channel of the rear case.
3. Slowly lift the rear housing up and place in a safe location.
4. Disconnect battery connector (J4) from the Power Supply board.
4.6.2 Removal of the Front Bezel (2)
1. Place the front housing with the display side down, onto a protective surface.
2. Disconnect the SpO2 ribbon cable (J3) from the CPU circuit board and the tubing
from the NIBP front panel connector.
3. Slowly separate the assembly up and away from the front housing.
4.6.3 Removal of the Keyboard Assembly (4)
1. Place the instrument with the display side down, onto a protective surface.
2. Remove the Front Bezel, as described above.
3. Remove the screws securing the Keyboard Assembly and lift the keyboard, supporting
and separating the connector to the CPU board.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 4 - Repair Information
Revised 6/25/99
4-9
4.6.4 Removal of the CPU Board Assembly (8)
1. Remove rear housing, front bezel and keyboard assembly. Reminder: Battery
must be disconnected.
2. Lift the Recorder and Temperature modules floating connectors, off the locator pins
on the main chassis.
3. Disconnect the ribbon cable connector (J1) from keyboard. NOTE: This is easier if
the NIBP assembly end is disconnected first.
4. Disconnect the Interface connector ribbon cable, (J-3) from the CPU board.
5. Disconnect the Speaker connector from (J-6) from the CPU board. Check for other
attached cables. Disconnect as required.
6. Remove the mounting screws from the CPU board. Leave the plastic insulator attached
to the chassis. Use a piece of adhesive tape, if required, to secure the insulator to the
chassis.
4.6.5 Removal of the NIBP Circuit Assembly (30)
1. Remove the rear housing of the monitor, as indicated above.
2. Disconnect Ribbon Cable connectors: (J1) to Filter board; (J2) to Power Supply board;
(J4) to CPU board.
3. Disconnect plastic tubing from center port of air pump. Pull out the remaining
plastic tubing, that was originally connected at the front panel cuff connector.
4. Remove the shield from the NIBP Module.
5. Remove the 3 screws from the NIBP Board; remove the board.
4.6.6 Removal of the Power Supply Assembly (41)
1. Remove the rear housing as indicated above.
2. Disconnect the ribbon cable at (J3).
PRECAUTION: Do not remove the screws located at the end of the circuit board: the board
will not come out and may damage internal connections.
3. Remove the two screws on the metal chassis/heat sink near J3, then remove two more
screws at the AC power input end. (J2)
4. Slide the complete assembly out, about one inch.
5. Disconnect (J2) the AC connector from the circuit assembly and slide out the Power
Supply assembly completely.
4-10
Revised 12/20/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 4 - Repair Information
4.6.7 Removal of the Motor Filter (34) and LCD High Voltage Assembly (35)
NOTE: The Motor Filter board and LCD High Voltage circuits are mounted on a
common metal heat sink and must be removed as one assembly.
1. Locate the assembly by tracing the wires from the air pump motor. Remove the three
screws in the chassis, in the area between the AC power connector assembly and the
back of the NIBP circuit.
2. Disconnect the LCD back light connector, (J1) and power connector, (J2).
3. Pull the assembly out towards the bottom of the unit and disconnect the ribbon
connectors at J6 and J5.
4.6.8 Removal of the NIBP Air Pump Assembly (37)
1. Remove the Motor Filter and LCD High Voltage assembly.
2. Remove motor connector (J5), from the Motor Filter board.
3. Disconnect plastic tubing from center port of air pump.
4. Remove remaining motor bracket retaining screw, (the other screw was removed as
part of the Motor Filter board removal) and slide air pump out of the retaining
bracket.
4.6.9 Removal of the LCD Display Assembly and Back Light (5)
1. Disconnect LCD Back Light cable connector (J1) at the LCD high voltage module.
2. Disconnect the LCD ribbon cable at the right of the display.
3. Remove the two screws of the LCD mounting bracket, on the left side only.
4. Slide bracket out and disengage the LCD display from the right side bracket.
5. Remove the two screws attaching the back light.
4.6.10
Removal of the SpO2 Circuit Board (40)
The SpO2 circuit board is located in a cavity between the Power Supply board and the
CPU board.
1. Disconnect the short ribbon cable from the CPU board (J7), to the SpO2 circuit
board.
2. Check and insure that the SpO2 cable to the front panel connector has been
disconnected during the front bezel removal.
3. Remove the four screws on the top end of the circuit board and pull the assembly out
of the chassis.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 4 - Repair Information
Revised 12/20/00
4-11
4.6.11
Removal and replacement of the Internal Sealed Lead Acid or Li-Ion
Battery
To remove the externally accessible battery, press the quick release tab on the battery
access door and open door. The battery is retained internally in a sliding compartment,
captured by a spring loaded release tab. Press the tab away from the battery; the battery
will eject with a spring assist mechanism.
Reverse the process to install the replacement battery.
NOTE: New batteries are shipped in a discharged state for safety reasons. A new battery
must be charged for 2 hours for Li-Ion or 8 hours for Sealed Lead Acid Battery before first
use. The monitor may be used with AC mains power during the charge cycle but battery
operation could be limited during this time.
4.6.12
Removal of the AC Input Receptacle Assembly (16)
1. Press the plastic locking tabs on the rear of the AC receptacle. A small screwdriver
may be inserted at the cut out on the left of the AC connector, to release the locking
tabs.
2. From the front side of the receptacle, starting at the edge closest to the Interface
connector, press upwards, while pulling the connector out.
3. Disconnect the cable end from the Power Supply circuit board.
4. Remove the locking nuts from the safety ground terminal stud; remove ground
conductor.
IMPORTANT NOTICE: Never re-install an AC receptacle forcibly removed. The plastic
locking tabs of the receptacle will be damaged, and if re-installed the receptacle may pull out in
normal use.
4.6.13
4-12
Thermal Printer (optional module)
1.
Detach the complete module from the main NIBP section, by removing the two
screws in the plastic housing. Grasp the plastic housing and pull to the rear to
disengage the Interface connector.
2.
Remove the two screws retaining the circuit board and the anti static shield assembly.
Remove the shield.
3.
Remove the remaining two screws and lift the circuit board out.
Revised 12/20/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 4 - Repair Information
4.6.14
Thermometer, Predictive (optional module)
1. Detach the complete module from the main NIBP section by removing the two
screws in the plastic housing. Grasp the plastic housing and pull to the rear to disengage the interface connector.
2. Disconnect the 9 V battery. NOTE: Newer modules do not contain a battery. Skip
this step.
3. Remove J2 and J3 connectors from the circuit board to front panel input receptacle.
NOTE: The connectors may be reversed or interchanged without affecting final
function.
4. Remove the three screws securing the circuit board and anti static shield. Remove
the assembly.
4.6.15
AccuTemp IR, Infrared Thermometer (optional module)
The AccuTemp has no user accessible adjustments or replaceable parts, except for the 9
Volt battery. If problems arise, contact Datascope Technical Service.
4.6.16
AccuTemp IR Mounting Cradle
The mounting cradle has no adjustments or replaceable parts. The mounting cradle
houses a small circuit board and a photocell sensor.
4.6.17
Communication Board (45)
1. Disconnect the rear panel 9 pin RS232 connector.
2. Disconnect the 3 pin connector on the top of the Communication Board leading to
the phone jack by the rear panel.
3. Remove the 3 mounting screws securing the Communication Board to the chassis.
4. Trace the wider ribbon cable (remove the NIBP shield) to the CPU Board. Disconnect
the connector. (NOTE: The keyboard may have to be removed for clearance.)
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 4 - Repair Information
Revised 12/20/00
4-13
This page intentionally left blank.
4-14
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 4 - Repair Information
5.0 ASSEMBLY AND SCHEMATIC DIAGRAMS
Schematic drawings and accompanying assembly drawings of printed circuit boards are
provided in the remainder of this chapter.
The following is a list of the drawings and the corresponding drawing number
(if available) and the page where it can be found.
Drawing Name
Drawing Part Number
Interconnect Diagram
MasimoÒ Interconnect Diagram
Predictive Thermometer Board Assembly
Predictive Thermometer Board Schematic
with Battery Schematic
Predictive Thermometer Board
Recorder Board Assembly
Recorder Board Schematic
NIBP Board Assembly
NIBP Board Schematic
Datascope SpO2 Board Assembly
Datascope SpO2 Board Schematic
Page
5-2
5-4
0670-00-0582
0387-00-0582
0387-00-0582
0670-00-0583-01
0670-00-0583-01
0670-00-0584-02
0387-00-0584-02
0670-00-0593-03
0387-00-0593-03
5-6
5-7
5-8
5-10
5-11
5-12
5-13
5-16
5-17
LCD Backlite Power Supply Board Assembly
LCD Backlite Power Supply Board Schematic
CPU Board with and without SpO2 Assembly
CPU Board with and without SpO2 Schematic
0670-00-0649
0387-00-0649
0670-00-0650-03/04
0387-00-0650-XX
5-20
5-21
5-22
5-23
Communication Board Assembly
Communication Board Schematic
0670-00-0661
0387-00-0661
5-28
5-29
0014-00-0184
5-30
0014-00-0225
0331-00-0102
0331-00-0103
0331-00-0104
0331-00-0108
5-32
5-34
5-35
5-36
5-37
Nellcor® Interface Board Assembly
Nellcor® Interface Board Schematic
0670-00-0675
0387-00-0675
5-38
5-39
MasimoÒ Interface Board Assembly
MasimoÒ Interface Board Schematic
0670-00-0716
0387-00-0716
5-40
5-41
Tone Processor Board Assembly
Tone Processor Board Schematic
0670-00-1134
0387-00-1134
5-42
5-43
Datascope SpO2 Daughter Board Asembly
Datascope SpO2 Daughter Board Schematic
0670-00-0724
0387-00-0724
5-14
5-15
Main Power Supply Board Schematic
(Sealed Lead Acid Battery)
Main Power Suply Board Schematic
(Li-Ion Battery)
Keyboard Schematics
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 5 - Schematics
Revised 12/21/00
5-1
Schematic Drawing
Main Power Supply Board
for Lithium-Ion Battery
0014-00-0125
Page 1 of 2
5-32
Schematic Drawing
Main Power Supply Board
for Lithium-Ion Battery
0014-00-0125
Page 2 of 2
5-33
This page intentionally left blank.
5-44
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 5 - Schematics
6.0 REPLACEMENT PARTS
CONTENTS OF THIS CHAPTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Page
6.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1
6.2 Available Replacement Parts and Sub-Assemblies. . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1
6.3 Product Variations and Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1
6.4 Exchange Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1
6.5 Replacement Parts Pricing Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2
6.6 Ordering Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2
6.7 Abbreviations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3
6.8 Isometric Drawings and Parts Lists. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5
6.9 Circuit Board Parts Lists. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-19
6.1
INTRODUCTION
This chapter of the Service Manual provides information necessary to identify the
replacement parts and assemblies of the instrument.
6.2
AVAILABLE REPLACEMENT PARTS AND SUB-ASSEMBLIES
The parts listings which follow are divided into two sections. The Isometric Drawings
and the accompanying parts lists identify the available chassis mounted components. A
listing for the components on each circuit board then follows.
6.3
PRODUCT VARIATIONS AND OPTIONS
Product variations, due to differences for various line voltages, options and languages
may require different components. These variations are reflected, where necessary, on the
parts lists.
6.4
EXCHANGE PROGRAM
Datascope offers an exchange policy for most of the printed circuit board assemblies. This
program may provide the most expedient method of servicing the equipment. A standard
charge for this service is made. Contact the Datascope Service Department for details
concerning this exchange program.
Many circuit boards make extensive use of multi-layer technology and high density
packaging. Individual component replacement is not recommended on these boards
unless the technician is properly equipped to repair multi-layer circuit boards.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
6-1
Circuit boards, returned as parts of the exchange program, that show evidence of improper
repair techniques and are damaged in the process are not considered for exchange.
Damaged boards will be invoiced at full value and no exchange credit will be applied.
6.5 REPLACEMENT PARTS PRICING INFORMATION
Current parts prices and exchange charges can be determined by contacting Datascope,
Order Entry Department.
6.6 ORDERING INFORMATION
Replacement parts and assemblies are available from Datascope Corp., and in Europe
from Datascope B.V. Please follow these guidelines when ordering replacement items for
the instrument.
1. Include the Model and Serial Number of the instrument.
2. Include the Datascope Part Number exactly as it appears in the Parts List under the
column, “Datascope Part Number.”
3. Include a description of the item.
EXAMPLE ORDERS:
(1) ea. P/N 0014-00-0184
Main Power Supply Board
Serial No. XXXX-XX
(2) ea. P/N 0212-12-0404
Screw, #4-40 x .25 lg. Pan Head,
Serial No. XXXX-XX
NOTES:
Datascope Corp. maintains a policy of continuous development for product improvement
and reserves the right to change materials, specifications, and prices without notice.
Many components are described with sufficient detail to permit procurement through
local commercial channels. This applies to hardware, such as screws and fasteners, as well
as to certain electronic components, such as resistors, capacitors, certain integrated circuits
and transistors. In some cases, components are selected by Datascope to meet special
performance criteria above and beyond the component manufactures specifications. This
may apply to solid state components, relays and batteries. The use of other than
Datascope components in these applications may result in degradation of reliability or
instrument performance.
6-2
Revised 12/20/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
6.7 ABBREVIATIONS
The following abbreviations may appear in the parts listings which follow and/or
through the manual.
Abbreviation
Term
Abbreviation
Term
A/D
AMP
Analog to Digital
Amplifier
NTWK
Network
OP
Operational
BUF
Buffer
CAP
Capacitor
PB
PIA
|CC
CER
CERM
CNTR
CONN
CONT
CONV
CPU
Carbon Composition
Ceramic
Ceramic
Counter
Connector
Controller
Converter
Central Processing Unit
POT
PRESS
PWR
Push Button
Peripheral Interface
Adapter
Potentiometer
Pressure]
Power
RAM
REC
RECT
REG
SLA
Random Access Memory
Receiver
Rectangular
Regulated RES Resistor
Sealed Lead Acid
DCDR
DIFF
DIA
DIO
D/A
Decoder
Differential
Diastolic
Diode
Digital to Analog
STG
STK
SUP
SW
SYST
Stage
Stacked
Supply
Switch
Systolic
ELEC
EPROM
Electrolytic
TANT
Erasable Programmable TRANS
Read Only Memory
TRANSIS
Tantalum
Transistor
Transistor
FXD
Fixed
VAR
VIA
I.C.
INT. CKT.
Integrated Circ
Integrated Circuit
Variable
Versatile Interface
Adapter
KYBD
Keyboard
|LED
Li-Ion
Light Emitting Diode
Lithium Ion
XDCR
XFMR
XSTL
XSTR
Transducer
Transformer
Crystal
Transistor
MF
MONO
MYLR
Metal Film|
Monostable
Mylar
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
Revised 12/20/00
6-3
COMPLETE
REAR HOUSING
25
2 PLACES
47
27
44
26
37 COMPRESSOR
28
LCD
POWER 35
SUPPLY
CAM
MAIN POWER
SUPPLY
39
32
23
41
24
22
37B
21
47
29
SHIELD
33
34
36
MOTOR
FILTER
NIBP
CIRCUIT
37A
COMPRESSOR
CABLE
50
51
2 PLACES
20
30
46
48
31
48A
40
4 PLACES
49 2 PLACES
40B SpO
CIRCUIT
40D
40A 40C
38
8
38A
15
CPU
8A
AC CABLE
16 ASSEMBLY
CHASSIS
KEYPAD
17 GROUND
4
LUG
43 43A
2 2A 2B
GRAPHIC
OVERLAY
9
12
4A
LCD
BRACKET,
COMMUNICATIONS
BOARD
LEFT
45
10
12A
LCD
BRACKET,
RIGHT
6
13
7
11 SPEAKER
5 LCD
DOWNLOAD
PORT
SERIAL
PORT
(PART OF #15)
DISPLAY
52
BATTERY
3
42
3A 3B
19
1A
1
14 14A 14B 14C
Isometric Drawing
Accutorr Plus - All Models
Revised 2/15/00
6-4
6.8 ISOMETRIC DRAWINGS AND PARTS LIST
6.8.1. Accutorr Plus Isometric Parts List (All Models)
Figure
No.
Description
Datascope
Part Number
1
1a
2
2a
2b
Pressure fitting
Tubing, 13" (front panel to NIBP module)
Bezel, front, Datascope ONLY
Bezel, front, NELLCOR® or Datascope
Bezel, front, MASIMO® Only
0103-00-0411
0008-10-0408
0380-00-0359-04
0380-00-0359-05
0380-00-0359-06
3
3a
3b
4
4a
SpO2 connector assembly Datascope
SpO2 connector assembly NELLCOR®
SpO2 connector assembly MASIMO®
Keypad, without graphic panels
Graphic panels
0012-00-1223
0012-00-1222-01
0012-00-1344
See Table.
See Table.
5
6
7
8
8a
LCD display with backlite
Interface cable, download, phone jack
Interface cable for LCD
CPU circuit board (with SpO2)
CPU circuit board (without SpO2)
0160-00-0034
0012-00-1089
0012-00-1085
0670-00-0650-03
0670-00-0650-04
9
10
11
12
12a
Interface cable (SpO2 to CPU)
Mounting screws for 9 pin Interface connector
Speaker with cable
LCD support brackets, left
LCD support brackets, right
0012-00-1238
0361-00-0164
0012-00-0257-05
0406-00-0756
0406-00-0755
13
14
14a
14b
14c
Speaker retainer bracket
Label, front bezel, no SpO2 option
Label, front bezel, w / DSCP SpO2
Label, front bezel, w / NELLCOR® SpO2
Label, front bezel, w / MASIMO® SpO2
0343-00-0097
0334-00-1509-01
0334-00-1509-02
0334-00-1509-03
0334-00-1509-04
15
16
17
18
19
Chassis
AC (mains) power inlet w/cable
Ground lug
not used
Battery, sealed lead acid
0441-00-0103
0012-00-0941
0124-00-0104-06
19a
20
20a
21
Battery, Li-Ion
Battery connector with cable, SLA
Battery connector with cable, Li-Ion
Cover plate, cam latch
0146-00-0069
0406-00-0754
0997-00-0944
0386-00-0212
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
0146-00-0043
Revised 12/20/00
6-5
6-6
Figure
No.
Description
Datascope
Part Number
22
23
24
25
26
Washer, shoulder, cam latch
Spring, torsion, cam latch
Cam latch with rubber friction tape
Friction strip, adhesive
Release handle
0221-00-0139
0214-00-0229
0380-00-0267
0215-00-0107
0380-00-0268
27
28
29
30
31
Rear housing complete with # 21-26
Interface cable, NIBP to power supply
Interface cable, NIBP to CPU
NIBP circuit module
Interface cable, NIBP to Filter PCB
0380-00-0357-02
0012-00-0943
0012-00-0944
0670-00-0584-02
0012-00-0986
32
33
34
35
36
Interface cable, NIBP to LCD Power Supply
Shield, plastic for NIBP
Motor filter circuit board
Inverter circuit for LCD backlite
Bracket, for Inverter and Motor filter
0012-00-0989
0349-00-0265
0670-00-0584-03
0670-00-0649
0406-00-0671
37
37a
37b
38
38a
Compressor for NIBP, 12 VDC
Cable for pump with quick connect term.
Insulator, NIBP connector
Plastic push fasteners for SpO 2 shield
Plastic fasteners for Masimo shield
0104-00-0008
0012-00-1015
0349-00-0314
0344-00-0242
0344-00-0249
39
40
40a
40b
40c
40d
Bracket for NIBP pump
SpO2 circuit board, Datascope
SpO2 circuit board, NELLCOR®
Interface board for NELLCOR ® SpO 2
SpO2 circuit board, Masimo®
Interface board for Masimo® SpO2
0343-00-0098
0670-00-0593-03
0671-00-0162
0670-00-0675
0671-00-0055
0670-00-0716
41
41a
42
43
43a
44
Power supply / batt. charger, sealed lead acid
Power supply / batt. Charger, Li-Ion
Insulator tubing, PVC, .75"
SpO2 board shield, NELLCOR®
SpO2 board shield, Masimo®
Shield, metal for NIBP module
0014-00-0184
0014-00-0225
0008-00-0324
0349-00-0306
0337-00-0134
0337-00-0120
45
46
47
48
48a
Communication circuit board
Screw for rear housing (4-40 x 1.25")
Screw for rear housing (6-32 x .313")
Battery door, with plastic hinge
Battery door, replacement only
0670-00-0661-01
0212-12-0420
0212-12-0605
0380-00-0358-02
0380-00-0358-01
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
Figure
No.
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
n/s
n/s
n/s
n/s
n/s
Description
Rubber feet, small
Rubber feet, large
Plastic hinge for batt. door, replacement only
Front bezel SpO2 connector screws for
Datascope SpO2
Tone Processor Board
Datascope
Part Number
0348-00-0191-02
0348-00-0191-01
0346-00-0043
0213-09-0405
0670-00-1134
Luer Plate
Internal Tooth Lock Washer
Hex Nut
Label, rear panel, (large label with finger
caution symbol)
Label, Agency approvals and serial number
0386-00-0162
0210-09-0025
0220-00-0004
Cable, Interface board to Masimo board
Nylon screws, Masimo board to Interface board
Front bezel SpO2 connector screws for
Nellcor and Masimo
0012-00-1338
0212-01-0404
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
334-00-1510
0334-00-1362- 03
0211-00-0140
Revised 12/20/00
6-7
FRONT PANEL KEYBOARDS AND GRAPHIC PANELS SELECTION
NOTE: When replacing a Keyboard, you must replace the Graphic Panel. Select correct
parts combinations based on unit configuration. ie: 0998-00-0444-51 Order
0331-00-0103 keyboard and 0330-00-0027-01 Graphic Panel.
NOTE: Unit configurations that contain an L, indicate that unit contains a Lithium-Ion
Battery.
Monitors with or without Datascope SpO2
Monitor Configuration Monitor Part Number
NIBP, Trend LCD, DSCP
SpO2 (USA, IEC,
English)
NIBP, Trend LCD
(USA, IEC, English)
NIBP only (USA, IEC,
English)
NIBP, Trend LCD,
DSCP SpO2 (IEC,
German)
NIBP, Trend LCD
(IEC, German)
NIBP only (IEC,
German)
NIBP, Trend LCD,
DSCP SpO2 (IEC,
Spanish)
NIBP, Trend LCD
(IEC,Spanish)
NIBP only (IEC,
Spanish)
NIBP, Trend LCD,
DSCP SpO2 (IEC,
French)
NIBP, Trend LCD
(IEC, French)
NIBP only (IEC,
French)
NIBP, Trend LCD,
DSCP SpO2 (IEC,
Italian)
NIBP, Trend LCD
(IEC,Italian)
NIBP only (IEC,
Italian)
NIBP, Trend LCD,
DSCP SpO2 (IEC,
Swedish)
NIBP, Trend LCD
(IEC, Swedish)
NIBP only (IEC,
Swedish)
6-8
Revised 12/20/00
Keypad Part Number
0998-00-0444-51
0998-00-0444-L51
0331-00-0103
Graphic Panel Part
Number
0330-00-0027-01
0998-00-0444-41
0998-00-0444-L41
0998-00-0444-31
0998-000444-L31
0998-00-0444-52
0998-00-0444-L52
0331-00-0102
0330-00-0026-01
0331-00-0104
0330-00-0025-01
0331-00-0103
0330-00-0027-02
0998-00-0444-42
0998-00-0444-L42
0998-00-0444-32
0998-00-0444-L32
0998-00-0444-53
0998-00-0444-L53
0331-00-0102
0330-00-0026-02
0331-00-0104
0330-00-0025-02
0331-00-0103
0330-00-0027-03
0998-00-0444- 43
0998-00-0444-L43
0998-00-0444- 33
0998-00-0444-L33
0998-00-0444-54
0998-00-0444-L54
0331-00-0102
0330-00-0026-03
0331-00-0104
0330-00-0025-03
0331-00-0103
0330-00-0027-04
0998-00-0444- 44
0998-00-0444-L44
0998-00-0444- 34
0998-00-0444-L34
0998-00-0444- 56
0998-00-0444-L56
0331-00-0102
0330-00-0026-04
0331-00-0104
0330-00-0025-04
0331-00-0103
0330-00-0027-06
0998-00-0444- 46
0998-00-0444-L46
0998-00-0444- 36
0998-00-0444-L36
0998-00-0444- 57
0998-00-0444-L57
0331-00-0102
0330-00-0026-06
0331-00-0104
0330-00-0025-06
0331-00-0103
0330-00-0027-07
0998-00-0444- 47
0998-00-0444-L47
0998-00-0444- 37
0998-00-0444-L37
0331-00-0102
0330-00-0026-07
0331-00-0104
0330-00-0025-07
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
With NELLCOR SpO2 only
Monitor Configuration Monitor Part Number
NIBP, Trend LCD
DSCP SpO2 (IEC,
English)
NIBP, Trend LCD
(IEC, English)
NIBP Only, (IEC,
English)
NIBP, Trend LCD,
NELLCOR SpO2
(USA, IEC, English)
NIBP, Trend LCD,
NELLCOR SpO2
(IEC, German)
NIBP, Trend LCD,
NELLCOR SpO2
(IEC, Spanish)
NIBP, Trend LCD,
NELLCOR SpO2
(IEC, French)
NIBP, Trend LCD,
NELLCOR SpO2
(IEC, Italian)
NIBP, Trend LCD,
NELLCOR SpO2
(IEC, Swedish)
NIBP Trend LCD
Nellcor SpO2 (IEC,
English)
Keypad Part Number
0998-00-0444-55
0998-00-0444-L55
0331-00-0103
Graphic Panel Part
Number
0330-00-0027-01
0998-00-0444-45
0998-00-0444-L45
0998-00-0444-35
0998-00-0444-L35
0998-00-0444-61
0998-00-0444-L61
0331-00-0102
0330-00-0026-01
0331-00-0104
0330-00-0025-01
0331-00-0108
0330-00-0027-01
0998-00-0444-62
0998-00-0444-L62
0331-00-0108
0330-00-0027-02
0998-00-0444-63
0998-00-0444-L63
0331-00-0108
0330-00-0027-03
0998-00-0444-64
0998-00-0444-L64
0331-00-0108
0330-00-0027-04
0998-00-0444-66
0998-00-0444-L66
0331-00-0108
0330-00-0027-06
0998-00-0444-67
0998-00-0444-L67
0331-00-0108
0330-00-0027-07
0998-00-0444-65
0998-00-0444-L65
0331-00-0108
0330-00-0027-01
Table 6-1a - Keypad and Graphic Overlay Part Numbers, NELLCOR
With Masimo SpO2 only
Monitor Configuration Monitor Part Number
NIBP, Trend LCD,
Masimo SpO2 (USA,
IEC, English)
NIBP, Trend LCD,
Masimo SpO2 (IEC,
German)
NIBP, Trend LCD,
Masimo SpO2 (IEC,
Spanish)
NIBP, Trend LCD,
Masimo SpO2 (IEC,
French)
NIBP, Trend LCD,
Masimo SpO2 (IEC,
Italian)
0998-00-0444-71
0998-00-0444-L71
0331-00-0108
Graphic Panel Part
Number
0330-00-0027-01
0998-00-0444-72
0998-00-0444-L72
0331-00-0108
0330-00-0027-02
0998-00-0444-73
0998-00-0444-L73
0331-00-0108
0330-00-0027-03
0998-00-0444-74
0998-00-01444-L74
0331-00-0108
0330-00-0027-04
0998-00-0444-76
0998-00-0444-L76
0331-00-0108
0330-00-0027-06
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
Keypad Part Number
Revised 12/20/00
6-9
With Masimo SpO2 only
Monitor Configuration Monitor Part Number
NIBP, Trend LCD
Masimo SpO2 (IEC,
English)
NIBP, Trend LCD,
Masimo SpO2 (IEC,
Swedish)
Keypad Part Number
0998-00-0444-75
0998-00-0444-L75
0331-00-01058
Graphic Panel Part
Number
0330-00-0027-01
0998-00-0444-77
0331-00-0108
0330-00-0027-07
Table 6-1b - Keypad and Graphic Overlay Part Numbers, Masimo
6-10
Revised 12/20/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
This page intentionally left blank.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
6-11
6.8.2 Recorder Module Isometric Parts List
Figure
No.
Description
Datascope
Part Number
1
2
3
4
5
Chart Paper Door
Chart Cutter
Recorder Main Housing
Printer Assembly w/printhead
Circuit Board, Includes Printer
0380-00-0274
0380-00-0275
0380-00-0273-01
0161-00-0015
0670-00-0583-01
6
Plastic Shield, Anti Static
0349-00-0251
N/S*
N/S*
N/S*
N/S*
Label, Serial Number
Label, Recorder Paper Replacement
Captive Screw for Mounting
Captive Washer for Above
0334-00-1304
0334-00-1435
0217-02-0003
0221-00-0121
*N/S are items not shown on drawing.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
Revised 12/20/00
6-13
6.8.3 Predictive Temperature Module Isometric Parts List
Figure
No.
Description
Datascope
Part Number
1
2
3
4
4a
5
Housing
Circuit Board
Anti Static Shield
Connector Assembly (with 9V battery)
Connector Assembly (without 9V battery)
Spacer, Probe
0380-00-0271
0670-00-0582
0349-00-0251
0012-00-0953
0012-00-1335
0432-00-0008
6
N/S*
N/S*
Washer, Flat
Captive Screw for Mounting
Captive Washer for Above
0221-00-0140
0217-02-0003
0221-00-0121
* Not shown
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
Revised 12/20/00
6-15
1
2
4
3
5
Isometric Drawing
Mobile Stand - Type 1
(Gray Base)
6-16
Revised 12/20/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
6.8.4
Mobile Stand Type 1 (Gray Base) Assembly Parts List
Figure
No.
Description
Datascope
Part Number
1
2
3
4
5
Basket
Pole Assembly
Base
Caster
Caster, Locking
0436-00-0100
0436-00-0099
0436-00-0098
0401-00-0023-01
0401-00-0023-02
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
Revised 12/20/00
6-17
1
2
3
4
6-18
Revised 12/20/00
Isometric Drawing
Mobile Stand - Type 2
(Black Base)
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
6.8.5
Mobile Stand Type 2 (Black Base) Assembly Parts List
Figure
No.
Description
Datascope
Part Number
1
2
3
4
Not Shown
Basket
Pole
Polyurethane Sheel
Base Casting
Replacement Hardware Kit
0436-00-0117-03
0436-00-0118
0401-00-0034
0436-00-0117-02
0040-00-0305
6.8.6
Mounting Options
Sample
Wall Mount
Any Model of the
Accutorr Plus
Accutorr Plus
Mounting Adaptor
0406-00-0728
Sample Rolling Stand
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
Revised 06/12/02
6-19
This page intentionally left blank.
6-20
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
Predictive Thermometer Bd Assy 0670-00-0582-XX
Item Part Number
No
Description
Reference
32
33
34
35
0289-00-3106
0309-00-5901
0309-00-8451
0311-05-2501
CAPACITOR SMD TANTALUM 20%, 10UF
RESISTOR METAL FILM 1/8 W 1%, 5.90K
RESISTOR METAL FILM 1/8 W 1%, 8.45K
RESISTOR VARIABLE 1/2W 20 TURN HORIZONTAL, 500
C27
R5
R7,R8
R1,R2
36
37
38
39
40
0320-00-5301
0320-00-7501
0324-00-0100
0324-00-0101
0324-00-0102
RESISTOR METAL FILM 0.1% 1/8W, 5.3K
RESISTOR METAL FILM 0.1% 1/8W, 7.5K
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM 1/4W 5%, 10
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM 1/4W 5%, 100
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM 1/4W 5%, 1.0K
R3
R4
R28
R30,R31
R29
41
42
43
0324-00-0104
0326-01-1002
0326-01-1003
R14-R21,R27
R13,R25
R12,R22,R23,R26
44
45
0326-01-2001
0326-01-2372
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM 1/4W 5%, 100K
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM 1/10W 1%, 10K
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM 1/10W 1%,
100K
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM 1/10W 1%, 2K
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM 1/10W 1%,
23.7K
46
0326-01-3921
R11
47
0326-01-4752
48
0388-00-0582 REV
F
0432-00-0008
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM 1/10W 1%,
3.92K
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM 1/10W 1%,
47.5K
PCB, PTM, Accutorr Plus
Mounting Electrical, .600 pitch
Single In-Line, XSW1
49
6-22
Revised 12/20/00
R24
R6
R9,R10
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
Recorder Board Assembly
Part Number
1
2
0108-00-0058
0108-00-0078
3
4
0136-00-0201
0136-00-0226
5
0136-57-0044
6
0136-92-0005
7
8
9
0151-00-0013
0151-00-0035
0151-00-0133
10
0153-00-0014
11
12
13
0153-00-0086
DIODE, PN, Rectifier, 1N5806
0155-00-0081
IC, Hex Inverter, CMOS, 4069
0155-00-0772-02 Quad 2 input NAND w/Schmitt
trigger input, 74HC132
0155-00-0868-01 IC, LB1257, 8 channel driver
D3
U3
U4
0155-90-0292-02 IC, Programmed, Printer Control
(LB1257)
0161-00-0015
RECORDER, Thermal Printer
Mechanism
0211-13-0206-00 SCREW, M2x0.4, 6mm long, pan
head, ss
0283-04-0104
CAPACITOR, Ceramic, 0.1uF,
100V, 10%
U1
21
0283-05-0102
C17
22
0283-10-1821
23
0290-00-0122
24
0290-07-2223
25
0307-06-2102
CAPACITOR, Ceramic, X7R,
1000pF, 200V, 10%
CAPACITOR, Ceramic,Ultra-Stable,
820pF, 100V, 5%
CAPACITOR ELECTROLYTIC,
Aluminum, 3300 µF, 10 V radial
CAPACITOR, Electrolytic, Aluminum,
22uF, 16V, 20%
RESISTOR NETWORK, 10 pin SIP,
1k
26
0311-01-1503
R1
27
0315-00-0101
28
0315-00-0102
29
0315-00-0103
30
0315-00-0104
RESISTOR, Variable 1/2W, 50k,
horizontal mount
RESISTOR, FIXED, Carbon film,
1/4 W, 100, 5%
RESISTOR, FIXED, Carbon film,
1/4 W, 1k, 5%
RESISTOR, FIXED, Carbon film,
1/4 W, 10k, 5%
RESISTOR, FIXED, Carbon film,
1/4 W, 100k, 5%
31
0315-00-0123
R3
32
0315-00-0164
RESISTOR, FIXED, Carbon film,
1/4 W, 12k, 5%
RESISTOR, FIXED, Carbon film,
1/4 W, 160k, 5%
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
Description
0670-00-0583
Item
No.
Bead, Leaded Ferrite
INDUCTOR FIXED, 150 µH, power
CONNECTOR PC, Test point
CONNECTOR PC, Receptacle, 9
pin flex cable
SOCKET, PLCC, 44 pin
CONNECTOR PC, Header, straight
locking and polarized, 5 pin
TRANSISTOR, PNP, 2N3906
TRANSISTOR, NPN, 2N3904
TRANSISTOR, 2N6715, NPN,
medium power
DIODE, PN Switching
1N4148/1N914
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
Reference
L1
L2
TP1
J3
XU1
J2
Q3
Q1, Q2, Q4, Q5
Q6, Q7
D1, D2
U2
C1, C2, C7, C8, C9, C10, C11, C12, C13, C14, C15
C16
C4, C5, C6
C3
RN1
R8, R9, R22, R23, R24, R25
R12, R14, R16
R7, R13, R15, R18
R6, R10, R11
R2
Revised 12/20/00
6-23
Recorder Board Assembly
Item
No.
Part Number
33
0315-00-0202
34
0315-00-0222
35
0315-00-0223
36
0315-00-0271
37
38
0388-00-0583
6-24
Description
RESISTOR, FIXED, Carbon film,
1/4 W, 2k, 5%
RESISTOR, FIXED, Carbon film,
1/4 W, 2.2k, 5%
RESISTOR, FIXED, Carbon film,
1/4 W, 22k, 5%
RESISTOR, FIXED, Carbon film,
1/4 W, 270, 5%
PCB, Recorder
THREADED INSERT, M2x0.4
Revised 12/20/00
0670-00-0583
Reference
R17 R19
R5
R4
R20, R21
PEM P/N KFS2-M204
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
NIBP Circuit Board Assembly
0670-00-0584-02
Item
No.
Part Number
Description
Reference
1
2
3
4
5
0008-10-0204
0008-10-0408
Tubing, 1/16"
Tubing, 1/8"
N/A
N/A
0103-00-0200
0103-00-0331
FTG, 1/8 to 1/16
Transition Barb, Rt Angle
N/A
N/A
6
7
8
0103-00-0420
PNEUMATIC MANIFOLD
N/A
0104-00-0005
9
0104-00-0006
PNEUMATIC COMPONENT,
VALVE, 12 VDC, 3- WAY, V1
MAGNETIC COMPONENT,
LINEAR VALVE, 12 VDC, N.C., V2
10
11
12
0108-00-0065
0108-00-0078
INDUCTOR, Dual winding
13
14
15
0136-00-0201
0136-82-0014
Test Pin
TP1
CONNECTOR PC, Header, straight J2
locking and polarized, 14 Pin
16
0136-87-0034
17
0136-92-0003
18
0136-92-0004
CONNECTOR PC, Shrouded
J4
straight header w/ejector, 34 Pin
CONNECTOR PC, Header, straight J3, J5
locking and polarized, 3 Pin
CONNECTOR PC, Header, straight J1, J6
locking and polarized, 4 Pin
19
20
0151-00-0115
TRANSISTOR, 2N7000, MOSFET
Q3, Q4, Q6, Q7
21
0151-00-0195
Q1, Q5
22
0151-01-0010
23
24
25
0153-00-0001
0153-00-0014
0153-00-0085
TRANSISTOR, IRLD014, N-channel
power MOSFET
TRANSISTOR, IRFD110,
N-channel MOSFET
DIODE, 1N4003
DIODE, 1N4148
DIODE, 1N6263
D1, D8
D10
D2, D3, D4, D5, D6, D7
26
27
28
29
30
0153-00-0193
DIODE, Zener, 1N4749A
D9
0155-00-0053
0155-00-0107
0155-00-0404
IC, LM324A, Quad OpAmp
IC, LM311, Comparator
IC, DG201A, Analog Switch
U4
U8
U5, U7
31
32
0155-00-0443
IC, LT1014, Quad OpAmp
0155-00-0805-02 IC, Dual picoamp input current
OpAmp, AD706
0155-00-0845-02 IC, TLC2543, 12 bit A/D converter
0155-00-0858
IC, LT1004-2.5, 2.5 V micropower
voltage reference
0283-04-0334
CAPACITOR, 0.33µF 10%, 50V
Ceramic
U1, U3
U2
36
0283-04-0104
CAPACITOR, 0.1µF 10%, 100V
Ceramic
C4, C6, C8, C10, C11, C13, C14, C17, C18, C20,
C21, C22, C25, C29, C31, C32, C33, C34, C51, C52
37
0283-04-0224
CAPACITOR, 0.22µF 10%, 50V
Ceramic
C12
33
34
35
INDUCTOR FIXED, 150 µH, power
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
L1
L2
Q2
U6
U12
C53
Revised 12/20/00
6-25
NIBP Circuit Board Assembly
Item
No.
Part Number
38
0283-04-0474
39
0283-05-0101
40
Description
0670-00-0584-02
Reference
CAPACITOR, 0.47µF 10%, 50V
Ceramic
CAPACITOR, 100pF 10%, 200V
Ceramic
C7, C19, C23, C24, C48, C50
0283-05-0103
CAPACITOR, 0.01µF 10%, 100V
Ceramic
C16, C26
41
0283-05-0220
CAPACITOR, 22pF 10%, 200V
Ceramic
C30
42
0283-05-0332
43
0285-00-0055
44
0285-15-1473
45
0290-02-3105
CAPACITOR, 0.0033µF 10%, 100V C15
Ceramic
C1, C2, C3, C5, C35
CAPACITOR, 0.47µF 5%, 63V
Poly.
C36
CAPACITOR, 0.047µF 5%, 63V
Poly.
C28
CAPACITOR, 1µF 10%, 35V,
Dipped Tantalum
46
0290-11-0001
CAPACITOR, 3300µF 20%, 16V,
Electrolytic
47
48
0307-00-0029
49
0307-01-0102
50
0309-00-1001
RESISTOR NETWORK, 14 PIN
RN1, RN2
DIP, 10K
RESISTOR NETWORK, 10 PIN
RN3
SIP, 1K
RESISTOR, Metal film, 1/8 W, 1% 1K R3, R7, R12, R15, R20
51
0309-00-1002
52
0309-00-1003
53
0309-00-1103
54
0309-00-1213
55
0309-00-1214
56
0309-00-1500
57
0309-00-1502
58
0309-00-1691
59
0309-00-1823
60
0309-00-2001
61
0309-00-2212
62
0309-00-2431
63
0309-00-3012
64
0309-00-3013
65
0309-00-3321
6-26
Revised 12/20/00
C9
C27
RESISTOR, Metal film, 1/8 W, 1%
10K
RESISTOR, Metal film, 1/8 W, 1%
100K
RESISTOR, Metal film, 1/8 W, 1%
110K
RESISTOR, Metal film, 1/8 W, 1%
121K
RESISTOR, Metal film, 1/8 W, 1%
1.21M
R5, R14, R49
RESISTOR, Metal film, 1/8 W, 1%
150 Ohm
RESISTOR, Metal film, 1/8 W, 1%
15K
RESISTOR, Metal film, 1/8 W, 1%
1.69K
RESISTOR, Metal film, 1/8 W, 1%
182K
RESISTOR, Metal film, 1/8 W, 1%
2K
R22
RESISTOR, Metal film, 1/8 W, 1%
22.1K
RESISTOR, Metal film, 1/8 W, 1%
2.43K
RESISTOR, Metal film, 1/8 W, 1%
30.1K
RESISTOR, Metal film, 1/8 W, 1%
301K
RESISTOR, Metal film, 1/8 W, 1%
3.32K
R13, R37, R45
R43
R23
R9, R46, R50
R17, R39
R56
R27
R48, R52
R47, R54
R11
R30
R42
R33
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
NIBP Circuit Board Assembly
Item
No.
Part Number
66
0309-00-3572
67
0309-00-3653
68
0309-00-3654
69
0309-00-3831
70
0309-00-4751
71
0309-00-5112
72
0309-00-5903
73
0309-00-6042
74
0309-00-7500
75
0309-00-8660
76
0310-00-0100
77
78
79
0311-01-1501
0311-01-2502
0315-00-0102
80
0315-00-0103
81
0315-00-0104
82
0315-00-0202
83
0315-00-0221
84
85
86
87
0212-10-0608
0344-00-0223
0220-22-0632
0378-02-0004
88
89
90
91
92
0388-00-0584
Description
0670-00-0584-02
Reference
RESISTOR, Metal film, 1/8 W, 1%
35.7K
RESISTOR, Metal film, 1/8 W, 1%
365K
RESISTOR, Metal film, 1/8 W, 1%
3.65M
RESISTOR, Metal film, 1/8 W, 1%
3.83K
RESISTOR, Metal film, 1/8 W, 1%
4.75K
R19
RESISTOR, Metal film, 1/8 W, 1%
51.1K
RESISTOR, Metal film, 1/8 W, 1%
590K
RESISTOR, Metal film, 1/8 W, 1%
60.4K
RESISTOR, Metal film, 1/8 W, 1%
750 Ohm
RESISTOR, Metal film, 1/8 W, 1%
866 Ohm
R16, R24
RESISTOR, Metal film, 1/4 W, 1%
10 Ohm
RESISTOR, Variable , 500 Ohm
RESISTOR, Variable, 5K
RESISTOR, Carbon film, 1/4 W,
5%, 1K
RESISTOR, Carbon film, 1/4 W,
5%, 10K
R1
RESISTOR, Carbon film, 1/4 W,
5%, 100K
RESISTOR, Carbon film, 1/4 W,
5%, 2K
RESISTOR, Carbon film, 1/4 W,
5%, 220 Ohm
Screw, Nylon, Std
Fastener, Snap-in
Nut, Hex, Nylon, Std
R55
R51
R26
R8
R10, R18
R57
R25, R58
R29
R1
R40
R28
R21, R34, R35
R2, R38, R41, R44, R53
R36
R6, R31, R32
N/A
Air Filter, 25 µm 1/8 barb
N/A
PCB, NIBP
N/A
0406-00-0762
Bracket, Sensors Mounting
N/A
0136-00-0295-06 CONNECTOR, Right Angle Socket,
6 Pin
93
0682-00-0072
94
0682-00-0086
TRANSDUCER, Blood pressure
sensor
TRANSDUCER, 7 PSIG with signal
conditioning
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
PT1
PT2
Revised 12/20/00
6-27
SpO2 Board Assembly
Part Number
1
2
3
5
6
0108-00-0019
0108-00-0020
0108-00-0058
0136-00-0201
0136-85-0010
Penta-filar wound
Tri-filar wound
Ferrite Bead
Test Point
CONNECTOR PC, Header,
shrouded right angle w/ejector
U17
U16
L1,L2,L3,L4
TP1-TP5, TP8-TP11
J1,J3
7
8
9
11
12
0151-00-0182
0151-00-0184
0153-00-0168
0153-00-0175
0153-00-0176
XSTR 5308 SMD
XSTR 2222A SMD
DIODE, SMD, 5239B
DIODE 914/4148 SMD
DIODE 6263 SMD
Q1,Q2, Q3
Q4
CR2
CR1,5,6,9,12,14,15,16,17
CR7
13
14
15
16
17
0155-00-0591-03
0155-00-0629
0155-00-0631
0155-00-0632
0155-00-0633
IC uPROCESSOR 63X09E
IC VOLTAGE REF 1004
IC PRCN OP-AMP OP-27
IC 12 BIT MULTI. DAC AD7541A
IC BI-FET SMP-HLD LF398
U34
U25
U4,U21
U29
U13
18
19
20
21
22
0155-00-0635-01
0155-00-0645
0155-00-0714
0155-00-0716
0155-00-0717
IC MICRO MONITOR
IC OPAMP TL032
IC HEX INVERTER 74HCT04
IC TL082CD
IC PRECISION OP-AMP
U35
U8,U9,U22
U30
U1,U2,U11
U6,U7
23
24
25
U28
U27
U3,U5,U10,U12
26
27
0155-00-0718
IC LM 337LM
0155-00-0719
IC LM317LM
0155-00-0720-01 IC DG201 QUAD SPST ANALOG
SW
0155-00-0721-03 IC 32KX8 STATIC RAM
0155-00-0753
IC COMPARATOR LM 311
28
29
30
31
0155-00-0822-01
0155-00-0901-03
0155-90-0235
0155-90-0297
32
0155-90-0298
IC TRI-STATE OCTAL 74HCT534
IC DUART, SCC2692AC1A44
IC PROGRAMMED PLD EP910I
IC PROGRAMMED FLASH ROM
(To be socketed.)
IC PROGRAMMED PLD EPM7032
U33,U39,U40
U14
U24 Blank chip is 0155-00-0494-12 (EP910ILC-15)
U26 Blank chip is 0155-00-0634-01
(AM29F010-90JC)
U23 Blank chip is 0155-00-0673-11
(EPM7032LC44-15)
33
34
35
36
37
0158-07-0012
0158-08-0005
0283-00-0056
0283-04-0474
0285-08-8201
CRYSTAL, CLOCK OSCILLATOR
Xtal, SMD, 3.6864 MHz.
CAP .1UF BYPASS
CAP .47 UF 50V 10% CER
CAP .0082uF POLYPROPYLENE
U31
Y1
C6-24,C30-34,C36-38,C41
C1-5
C68
38
38
39
39
40
0285-15-0104
0285-15-2104
0285-15-0223
0285-15-2223
0286-00-2101
CAP POLYCARB. .1UF 63V 2.5%
CAP POLYCARB. .1UF 50V 1%
CAP POLYCARB. .022 UF 100V 2.5%
CAP POLYCARB. .022 UF 75V 1%
CAP 100PF 100V 5% CER
C58-60,C65
C58-60,C65 )Alternate)
C61-63,C66
C61-63,C66 (Alternate)
C49
41
42
43
44
45
0286-00-2102
0286-00-2220
0286-00-2221
0286-00-2470
0286-00-2471
CAP 1000PF 50V NPO
CAP 22PF 100V 5% CER
CAP 220PF 100V 5% CER
CAP 47 PF 100V 5% CER
CAP 470PF 100V 5% CER
C40,C42
C29,C35,C48,C51,C53,C54
C56
C55
C57
6-28
Description
0670-00-0593-03
Item
No.
Revised 06/01/01
Reference
U18
U36
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
SpO2 Board Assembly
Item
No.
Part Number
46
47
48
49
50
0287-00-1103
0287-01-1104
0289-01-2106
0289-01-2226
0307-11-0472
51
Description
0670-00-0593-03
Reference
C28,C50
C25-27,C52
C64,C67,C69,C70,C71,C72
C45,C47,C73,C74,C75
RN1,RN2,RN3,RN4
0320-00-1004
CAP .01 UF 50V 10% CER
CAP .1UF 25V 10% CER
CAP 10 UF 35V 20% ALUM
CAP 22 UF 35V 20% ALUM
Resistor Network (x4), 4.7K,
0.063W
RES 1 M .1% .1W
52
53
54
55
56
0320-00-2913
0320-00-5302
0324-01-10R0
0324-01-22R1
0324-01-27R4
RES 291K .1% .1W
RES 53.OK .1% .1W
RES 10 ohm 1% 1/4W
RES 22.1 ohm 1% 1/4W
RES 27.4 ohm 1% 1/4W
R21
R94
R3,R10,R30,R46
R2
R1
57
58
0326-00-0106
0326-01-1001
RES 10M 5% .1W
RES 1K 1% .1W
R34
R7,R11,R12,R15,R28,R33,R44,R55,R62,R67,R69,R
72,R77,R90, R104
59
0326-01-1002
RES 10K 1% .1W
60
61
62
63
0326-01-1003
0326-01-1004
0326-01-1243
0326-01-1333
RES 100K 1% .1W
RES 1M 1% .1W
RES 124K 1% .1W
RES 133K 1% .1W
R6,R17,R23,R24,R38,R40,R61,R70,R71,R75,R82,R
102,R111,R112
R9,R14,R16,R27,R36,R51,R74
R45,R49,R85,R91
R42,R59,R65,R87
R4
64
65
66
67
68
0326-01-1472
0326-01-1502
0326-01-1503
0326-01-1621
0326-01-1652
RES 14.7K 1% .1W
RES 15K 1% .1W
RES 150K 1% .1W
RES 1.62K 1% .1W
RES 16.5K 1% .1W
R47
R43
R39,R41,R52,R58,R60,R66,R73,R83,R84
R68,R92
R37
69
70
71
72
73
0326-01-2003
0326-01-2320
0326-01-3013
0326-01-3241
0326-01-3742
RES 200K 1% .1W
RES 232 ohm 1% .1W
RES 301K 1% .1W
RES 3.24K 1% .1W
RES 37.4K 1% .1W
R8
R76,R89
R80
R25
R88
74
75
76
77
78
0326-01-3922
0326-01-3923
0326-01-4750
0326-01-4751
0326-01-4752
RES 39.2K 1% .1W
RES 392K 1% .1W
RES 475 1% .1W
RES 4.75K 1% .1W
RES 47.5K 1% .1W
R29,R57
R18,R31
R108
R13
R53,R63
79
80
81
82
83
0326-01-4753
0326-01-5111
0326-01-6653
0326-02-1002
0388-00-0593
RES 475K 1% .1W
RES 5.11K 1% .1W
RES 665K 1% .1W
RES 10K .1% .1W
PCB, SpO2
R26
R32,R48
R5
R19,R20,R35,R50,R54
84
85
86
87
88
0212-12-0403
0406-00-0693
0349-00-0276
0153-00-0197
0361-09-0402
Screw, Pan Head
Bracket
Insulator, SpO2
Diode Suppressor
PEM SS Standoff (KFSE-440-4)
89
90
0136-57-0085
PLCC Socket
0136-22-0040-01 Test Point
Accouter Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
R22
Not used in -03 boards
Not used in -03 boards
D6,7,8,9
XU34
TP6,TP7
Revised 12/18/00
6-29
LCD Backlite Power Supply Board
Part Number
1
2
3
4
5
0014-00-0180
0136-91-0003
0136-91-0004
0151-00-0195
0153-00-0001
Power Supply, DC to AC inverter
CONNECTOR PC, Header,right angle
COINNECTOR PC, Header, right angle
Transistor, IRLD014 MOS FET
Diode, IN4003
T1 - ERG - JLA 12-202P
J2
J1
Q1
D1
6
7
8
9
10
0283-04-0104
0290-01-1221
0315-00-0104
0385-00-0649
CAP, 0.1uF 10%, 100V Ceramic
CAP, 220uF, 5%, -10%, 25V Alum
RES., 100K 5%, 1/4W
PCB, LCD Power
C1,C3
C2
R1
6-30
Description
0670-00-0649
Item
No.
Revised 12/20/00
Reference
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
CPU/LED Board
0670-00-0650-03/04
Item
No.
Part Number
Reference
1
0014-00-0181
2
3
0108-00-0058
0012-00-1237
4
0134-17-0030
5
0136-85-0010
6
0136-85-0020
7
0136-85-0026
8
0136-85-0034
9
0136-91-0003
10
0150-00-0058
11
12
13
14
0150-00-0059
0150-00-0060-01
0150-00-0060-03
0151-00-0013
15
0151-00-0035
16
0151-00-0190
17
0153-00-0175
18
19
0153-00-0177
0155-00-0518
20
0155-00-0645
21
22
0155-00-0692
0155-00-0696
23
24
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
Description
Power Supply DC/DC Converter
1W 15V Dual Output
Inductor Fixed Ferrite Bead
Cable Assembly, Module, 20 pin
IDC PC mount to 20 pin card edge
receptacle
Connector PC Receptacle Dual
Row .100 Pitch
Connector PC Header Shrouded
Right Angle w/Ejector
Connector PC Header Shrouded
Right Angle w/Ejector
Connector PC Header Shrouded
Right Angle w/Ejector
Connector PC Header Shrouded
Right Angle w/Ejector
Connector PC Header Right Angle
Locking and Polarized
Readout 7 Segment LED .8
T1
L1-L3
J5
J2
J7
J3
J8
J1
J6
DS1-DS6
Readout 4 Digit LED .28
Readout, DS10-DS12
Readout, DS7-DS9
Transistor 2N3906 PNP General
Purpose
Transistor 2N3904 NPN General
Purpose
DS13-DS15
GREEN, SEVEN SEGMENT LED 0.56
RED, SEVEN SEGMENT LED 0.56
Q8,Q9
Transistor SMD N Channel TMOS
FET 2N7002
Diode SMD General Purpose
Switching D914
Diode 1N5817 Schottky Rectifier
IC Multiprotocol Processor
MC68302
IC Dual JFET OPAMP TL032C
Q1-Q3,Q5
Q7
D3-D5
D1,D2
U1
U23
IC 74HCT08 Quad 2 Input and Gate
IC 74HCT74 Flip-Flop Dual D-Type
Positive - Edge Triggered
0155-00-0711-01 IC Octal Buffer/Line Driver
74HCT244
0155-00-0731-01 IC Quad 2 Input NOR Gate
74HCT02
U31
U47,U48
0155-00-0741
IC TLC555C Timer Low Power
0155-00-0772-01 IC Quad 2 Input NAND w/Schmitt
Trigger Input 74HC132
0155-00-0778
IC Audio Power Amplifier LM386
0155-00-0779
IC Low Power Dual OPAMP LM358
0155-00-0782-01 IC 1 OF 8 Decoder / Multiplexer
74HCT138
U33
U14,U15
U2,U6,U37
U20,U13,U16
U25
U24
U11
0155-00-0813-01 IC Octal D Flipflop w/Reset
U7
74HCT273
0155-00-0816-01 IC 74HCT139 Dual 2-4 Line
U12,U29
Decoder/Demultiplexer
0155-00-0851
IC 7218A 8 Digit LED Display Driver U8-U10
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
Revised 12/20/00
6-31
CPU/LED Board
0670-00-0650-03/04
Item
No.
Part Number
Reference
61
0289-00-3476
62
0289-01-2106
63
0289-01-2226
64
0289-01-4226
65
0289-01-4476
66
0289-01-5107
67
0307-20-2202
68
0307-21-1000
69
0324-00-0100
70
0324-00-0101
71
0324-00-0103
72
0324-00-0104
73
0324-00-0122
74
0324-00-0330
75
0326-00-0101
76
0326-01-1000
77
0326-01-1001
78
0326-01-1002
79
0326-01-1003
80
0326-01-1004
81
0326-01-2001
82
0326-01-2003
83
0326-01-2211
84
0326-01-2492
85
0326-01-2741
86
0326-01-3321
87
0326-01-3323
Description
CAPACITOR SMD TANTALUM
20%, 47UF
CAPACITOR SMD
ELECTROLYTIC 20%, 10UF
CAPACITOR SMD
ELECTROLYTIC 20%, 22UF
CAPACITOR SMD
ELECTROLYTIC 20%, 22UF
CAPACITOR SMD
ELECTROLYTIC 20%, 47UF
C7-C9
CAPACITOR SMD
ELECTROLYTIC 20%, 100UF
RESISTOR SPECIAL NETWORK
15 ELEMENT BUSSED 1%, 22.0K
RESISTOR NETWORK 8
ELEMENT ISOLATED , 100 ohm
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM
1/4W 5%, 10
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM
1/4W 5%, 100
C66
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM
1/4W 5%, 10K
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM
1/4W 5%, 100K
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM
1/4W 5%, 1.2K
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM
1/4W 5%, 33
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM
1/10W 5%, 100
R1
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM
1/10W 1%, 100
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM
1/10W 1%, 1K
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM
1/10W 1%, 10K
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM
1/10W 1%, 100K
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM
1/10W 1%, 1MEG
R20,R35,R43,R46,R47,R49,R52,R53,R55-R71,R73R75,R77,R79-R89
R4-R6,R17,R25,R37-R40,R54
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM
1/10W 1%, 2K
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM
1/10W 1%, 200K
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM
1/10W 1%, 2.21K
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM
1/10W 1%, 24.9K
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM
1/10W 1%, 2.74K
R31,R36
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM
1/10W 1%, 3.32K
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM
1/10W 1%, 332K
R16
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
C63
C61,C62
C11,C65,C80
C5,C6,C10,C81
RN1-RN4
RN6,RN8,RN10
R28-R30
R14,R23,R24
R44
R10
R32
R50
R2,R7,R9,R13,R15,R18,R19,R21,R22,R27,R33,R34
,R42,R78
R11,R48,R72
R3,R90
R12
R26
R45
R8
Revised 12/20/00
6-33
CPU/LED Board
0670-00-0650-03/04
Item
No.
Part Number
Reference
88
0326-01-7680
89
0326-01-8063
90
0326-01-9533
91
92
93
95
0388-00-0650
0432-00-0005
0136-10-0023
0155-90-0413
PCB, CPU MODULE
MOUNTING, 0.28" LED
MOUNTING, 0.8" LED
IC, Programmed, Accutorr
96
97
98
0155-90-0412
0136-10-0015
0012-00-1236
99
0326-01-2212
IC, Programmed, Accutorr
MOUNTING, 0.56" LED
Cable Assembly, Module, 20 pin
IDC PC mount to 20 pin card edge
receptacle
Resistor SMD Thick Film 1%, 22.1K
6-34
Revised 12/20/00
Description
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM
1/10W 1%, 768
Resistor SMD Thick Film 1/10W
1%, 806K
Resistor SMD Thick Film 1/10W
1%, 953K
R51
R41
R76
XDS13, XDS14, XDS15
2 per for DS2&DS4, DS3&DS5 and DS1&DS4
U3
U27
for DS7- DS12
J4
R91
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
Communication Board
Item
No.
Part Number
1
0012-00-1090
2
0012-00-1091
3
4
0108-00-0089
0136-92-0003
5
0151-00-0190
6
0151-00-0203
7
0153-00-0175
8
0153-00-0186
9
0153-00-0211
10
0155-00-0676
11
0155-00-0692
Description
Cable Assembly RS232 9 PIN D TO
10 PIN IDC PC Mount
Cable Assembly 20 PIN IDC TO 20
PIN IDC PC Mount
Inductor Dual Surface Mount, 20UH
Connector PC Header Straight
Locking and Polarized
Transistor SMD N Channel TMOS
FET 2N7002
0670-00-0661-01
Reference
J2
J1
L1
J3
Q2
Transistor MMFT3055 MOSFET
POWER Switching SMD
Diode SMD General Purpose
Switching D914
Diode 1N5819 Schottky Rectifier,
SMD MELF
Diode SM14M24 Transient Voltage
Suppressor SMD
IC Low Power Transceiver RS485
LTC485
Q1
IC QUAD 2 Input NAND GATE
74HCT08
0155-00-0958-02 IC MAX239 Multichannel RS232
Driver/Receiver
0155-00-0960-02 IC MAX1771 DC-DC Controller
High Efficiency
0283-00-0056
Capacitor SMD 0805 Ceramic
0.1UF 20%
0287-00-1103
Capacitor SMD 0805 Ceramic X7R
10%, 0.01UF
U4
16
0289-02-6106
C3
17
0289-00-3106
18
0289-00-3475
19
0289-02-4336
20
0289-00-5226
Capacitor SMD Tantalum 20%,
10UF, 35 VDC
Capacitor SMD Tantalum 20%,
10UF
Capacitor SMD Tantalum 20%,
4.7UF
Capacitor SMD Tantalum 20%,
33UF
Capacitor SMD Tantalum 20%,
22UF
21
0327-00-0R10
R1
22
0326-00-0121
23
0326-00-0472
24
0326-01-1000
25
0326-01-1002
Resistor SMD 1/4W 5% Low Value,
0.1
Resistor SMD Thick FILM 1/10W
5%, 120
Resistor SMD Thick FILM 1/10W
5%, 4.7K
Resistor SMD Thick FILM 1/10W
1%, 100
Resisotr SMD Thick FILM 1/10W
1%, 10K
26
0326-01-2003
R3
27
0326-01-2802
28
0388-00-0661
Resistor SMD Thick FILM 1/10W
1%, 200K
Resistor SMD Thick FILM 1/10W
1%, 28K
PCB, Communications Module
12
13
14
15
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
D2
D1,D3
U3
U5
U2
U1
C1,C9,C10,C12,C15,C16 (C13-14 -02 ONLY)
C7,C11, C18
C5
C6
C2,C4,C17
C8
R8
R10
R9
R4-R6
R2
Revised 12/20/00
6-35
Power Supply, Sealed Lead Acid
Item
No.
Part Number
Description
1
2
3
4
5
Fuse, Micro, time lag 4A/250 V
PC Assembly Dwg.
Inductor, GPx80’s
Choke Noise
XFMR, Current, EP7
F1, F2
6
7
8
9
10
XMFR-EMI Inductor, GPM40’s
Output Storage Choke
XFMR DC/DC, MSP1510
XFMR-Power, MSP1510
SEC Heatsink, MSP1510
T6
L2
T3
T2
FN1
11
12
13
14
15
PRI FET Bracket, MSP1510
Sub Assy B/M
Cap DK R Acy 250V 220PF
Cap MO R Z5U 1.0 MF 20%
Cap MO A X7R 50V 0.001 MF 10%
FN2
A1
C5,6
C23.47,53
C51
16
17
18
19
20
Cap MO Z X7R 50V 0.1 MF 10%
Cap MO A X7R 50V 0.0047 MF 10%
Cap Al R 1 25V 100.00MF KME
Cap Al R 1 63V 10.00MF KME
Cap Al R 1 25V 47.00MF KME
C55
C54
C43
C30
C2,17,21,32
21
22
23
24
25
Cap AL R 1 35V 390.00MF LXF
Cap AL R 1 35V 220.00MF LXF
Cap AL R 1 400V 82.00MF KMH
Cap FI R ACX 250V 0.100MF
Tstr P 60V 0.6A 2907A
C14,16,19,42,45
C11,12,17,34
C7
C1
C6,12
26
27
28
29
30
Tstr P 40V 3.0A TIP32
Tstr FET N 600V 6.0A MTP6N60
Tstr FET N 60V 35.0A IRFZ44
Tstr FET P 60V 12.0A MTP2955E
Tstr FET N 100V 1.0A IRFD110
Q3
Q1
Q11
Q5
Q16
31
32
33
34
35
Tstr FET P 45V 0.18A BS250
Rect 1xSCH 45V 10A MBR1045
Rect 1xUFR 300V 8A BYTO8P300
Diode ZNR 1.0W 5% P 3.3V
Diode ZNR 1.0W 5% P 18.0V
Q2
CR9,10
CR11
CR14
CR4
36
37
38
39
40
Rect UFR 1000V 1.0A MUR1100 P
Rect Bridge 600V 2A Small
IC VR ADJ SHUNT TL431 TO-92
IC VR - 15V 4% 0.5A 79M15 TO220
IC VR +15V 4% 0.5A 78M15 TO220
CR2
CR1
U4
U3
U5
41
42
43
44
45
IC Volt Detector ICL7665CPA
SCR 50V 8.0A S-Gate TO-220
Opto-Coupler TSTR 4N35
IC PWM Current Mode 3844
IC PWM Current Mode 3843
U8
SCR1
U2
U1
U6
46
47
48
IC PWM Current Mode 3845
Varistor 300VAC 80J
IC Batt Charger UC3906
U9
M1
U7
6-36
Revised 12/20/00
0014-00-0184
Reference
T1
L1,3
T4, 5
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
Power Supply, Sealed Lead Acid
Item
No.
Part Number
Description
49
50
Res F CF 1/4W 5% P 27.0 Ohm
Res F CF 1/4W 5% P 4.7 Ohm
R36
R18
51
Res F CF 1/2W 5% P 220.0 OK
Ohm
Res F MO 1W 5% MP 470.00 Ohm
Res F MF 1/4W 1% P 16.50K Ohm
Res F MF 1/4W 1% P 26.70K Ohm
Res F MF 1/4W 1% P 274.00K
Ohm
R25
52
53
54
55
56
0014-00-0184
Reference
R59
R37
R57
R57
57
58
59
60
Res F MF 1/4W 1% P 226.00K
Ohm
Res F MF 1/4W 1% P 7.32K Ohm
Res F MO 2W 5% P 120.00K Ohm
Res F MO 2W 5% NP 33.00K Ohm
Thermistor NTC 10.0 Ohm 1.7A
R8
R2
R16
RT1
61
62
63
64
65
Res F MO 1W 5% NP 10.00K Ohm
Res F MO 1W 5% NP 220.00 Ohm
Res V CE 1/3W H-Adj 500 Ohm
Res F MO 1W 5% P 0.47 Ohm
Res F CF 1/8W 5% SP 47.0K Ohm
R46
R33
R80
R1,22
R38
66
67
68
69
70
Res F CF 1/8W 5% SP 330.0 Ohm
Res F CF 1/8W 5% SP 820.0 Ohm
Res F CF 1/8W 5% SP 56.0K Ohm
Res F CF 1/8W 5% SP 100.0 Ohm
Res F MF 1/8W 1% P 365.00K Ohm
R61
R79
R81
R19
R45
71
72
73
74
R56
R77
R49
R17
75
Res F MF 1/8W 1% P 1.37M Ohm
Res F MF 1/8W 1% P 475.00 Ohm
Res F MF 1/8W 1% P 60.40K Ohm
Res F MF 1/8W 1% P 681.00K
Ohm
Res F MO 1/4W 5% P 22.00 Ohm
76
77
78
79
80
Res F MO 1/4W 5% P 47.00 Ohm
Res F MO 1/4W 5% P 33 Ohm
Res F MO 1/4W 5% P 4.70 Ohm
Res F MO 1/4W 5% NP 10.00 Ohm
Res F MO 1/4W 5% P 150.00 Ohm
R3,32
R44
R53
R28
R58
81
82
83
84
85
Res F MO 1/4W 5% P 220.00 Ohm
Wire Jumper Ins 22GA 0.300
Wire Jumper Ins 22GA 0.400
Sleeving Heatshrink Blk 3/4"
Wire Preformed Test Point
R12
W2
W1
FOR:M1
FOR:COM, VBULK
86
87
88
Conn. Hdr. 1 Ctr Locking 14 Pos
Conn Hdr. Amp 640445-3
Conn., PCB, HDR., LCK.,
PTL/LDG, 3C
Fusectip 5X20MW Brass
SPRINGCLIP, MOUNTING, TO-220
J3
J4
J2
Nut, Assem LK Wash, 4-40, STD
PAT
FN4
89
90
91
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
R4,21
R14
FOR:F3
FN3
Revised 12/20/00
6-37
Power Supply, Sealed Lead Acid
Item
No.
Part Number
Description
0014-00-0184
Reference
92
93
94
95
Screw, PNHD, 4-4OX, .312, PHIL
Screw, PNHD, 4-40 X .437, PHIL
Standoff, Swage, 4-40 x.125
Washer, Shoulder, 4-40x.090
FN5
FN6
FN7
FN8
96
97
98
99
100
Screw, FLHD 4-40x.312, 100 DEG
Washer, Shoulder, TO-220
Insulator Silpad 0.6" x 0.87"
Insulator Silpad 0.6" x 0.87"
Fuse 5X20 U/C T 4.00A 125V
FN9
FN10
FN12
FN12
F3
101
102
103
104
105
Tubing Teflon Clear 20GA
PCB-BARE, D/S. MSP1510, PN1X
Cap MO SM X7R 50V 100NF 1206
Cap MO SM Z5U 50V 330NF 1210
Cap MO SM X7R 100V 10NF 1206
FOR:R46,59
PCB
C24,33,35,36,44,48,49,50
C15,22,46
C4,13,27,28, 29,31
106
107
108
C3,8,25,26,37,38,52
C39
C9
109
110
Cap MO SM X7r 200V 1000PF 1206
Cap MO SM X7R 200V 2200PF 1206
Cap MO SM X7R 200V 470PF
1206
Cap MO SM X7R 200V 4700PF 1206
Cap MO SM X7R 500V 10NF 1210
C41
C10,20,40
111
112
113
114
115
Tstr N 40V 0.6A MBT2222A
Tstr P 60V 0.6A MBT2907A
Diode ZNR 0.5W 5% SMD 5.6V
Diode ZNR 0.5W 5% SMD 13.0V
Diode ZNR 0.5W 5% SMD 20.0V
Q7,10,14
Q4,13, 15
CR18
CR12, 19
CR8
116
117
118
119
120
Diode Signal DL4448
Rect UFR 200V 1.0A MUR120 SMT
Res F SM 1/4W 1% 365.00K Ohm
Res F SM 1/4W 1% 1.00K Ohm
Res F SM 1/4W 1% 10.70K Ohm
CR15, 20,22,23,24,26
CR3,6,7,16,17,21
R30,50,62
R5,13,31,34,43,69,70,71,78
R10,23,63,64,76
121
122
123
124
125
Res F SM 1/4W 1% 1.24K Ohm
Res F SM 1/4W 1% 1.30K Ohm
Res F SM 1/4W 1% 13.70K Ohm
Res F SM 1/4W 1% 1.50K Ohm
Res F SM 1/4W 1% 17.80K Ohm
R9,39
R40
R7
R42
R72
126
127
128
129
130
Res F SM 1/4W 1% 221.00 Ohm
Res F SM 1/4W 1% 2.21K Ohm
Res F SM 1/4W 1% 22.10K Ohm
Res F SM 1/4W 1% 44.20K Ohm
Res F SM 1/4W 1% 475.00 Ohm
R20
R26,29
R41
R27
R6,35
131
132
133
134
135
Res F SM 1/4W 1% 4.75K Ohm
Res F SM 1/4W 1% 49.90K Ohm
Res F SM 1/4W 1% 7.50K Ohm
Res F SM 1/4W 5% 10.0 Ohm
Res F SM 1/4W 5% 47.0 Ohm
R11,55,66
R24
R51
R54
R15,60
136
137
Res F SM 1/3W 5% 1.0K Ohm
Fuse, Micro, Time Lag 4A/125V
R65,67,68
F3
6-38
Revised 12/20/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
Power Supply, Lithium Ion
Item
No.
Part Number
0014-00-0225
Description
Reference
1
2
3
4
5
PCB-BARE,SMT D/S,MSP1698,PN1X
INDUCTOR,GPx80'S
CHOKE,NOISE
XFMR,CURRENT,EP7
XFMR-EMI INDUCTOR
PCB
T1
L1,3
T4,5
T6
6
7
8
9
10
OUTPUT STORAGE CHOKE
XFMR-DC/DC,MSP1698
XFMR-POWER,MSP1698
INDUCTOR,MSP1698
PRI FET BRKT W/HDWR,MSP1510
L2
T3
T2
L4
FN1
11
12
13
14
15
L BRKT W/HDWR & S/S,MSP1698
Cap DK R ACY 250V 220PF
Cap DK R X7R 1KV 125C 10000PF
Cap AL R 105C 25V 100.00MF S
Cap AL R 105C 25V 47.00MF S
FN1
C5,6
C10
C43
C18,21
16
17
18
19
20
Cap AL R 105C 50V 47.00MF S
Cap AL Lo-Z 105C 35V 390MF
Cap AL Lo-Z 105C 35V 220MF
Cap AL R 105C 400V 82MF 22X30
Cap FI R ACX 275V 0.100MF
C2
C16,19,42,45
C11,12,34
C7
C1
21
22
23
24
25
Cap Tant SMT 10.0uF 20V 3528
Cap Tant SMT 1.0uF 16V 3612
Cap SMT 10.0nF 10% 100V 0805
Cap SMT 0.1uF 10% 25V 0805
Cap SMT 1.0nF 10% 100V 0805
C32,35,58
C23,47,48,53
C4,13,20,27,28,29,49
C24,30,33,36,44,50,55
C8,25,38,51,52
26
27
28
29
30
Cap SMT 47.0nF 10% 50V 0805
Cap SMT 1.0nF 5% 50V 1206
Cap SMT 4.7pF 10% 50V 0805
Cap SMT 2.2nF 10% 200V 1206
Cap SMT 470.0pF 10% 200V 1206
C31
C3,26,37,41
C57
C39,56
C9,40,59
31
32
33
34
35
Cap SMT 4.7nF 10% 200V 1206
Cap SMT 0.33uF 20% 50V 1210
Tstr P 60V 0.6A 2907A
Tstr FET N 600V 6.0A TO-220
Tstr FET P 45V 0.18A BS250
C54
C15,22,46
Q6
Q1
Q2
36
37
38
39
40
Tstr N 40V 0.6A MBT2222A
Tstr P 60V 0.6A MBT2907A
Tstr FET N 60V 20.0A D-PAK
Tstr FET P 30V 19.0A D-PAK
Tstr FET N 60V .12A SOT23
Q7,8,9,10,14,17,20
Q4,12,13,15,18,19
Q11
Q3
Q16
41
42
43
44
45
Tstr FET P 60V 12.0A TO-220
Rect UFR 1000V 1.0A MUR1100 P
Rect Bridge 600V 2A Small
Rect SCH 40V 3.0A SMD
Rect 2 X SCH 40V 3.0A SMD
Q5
CR20
CR1
CR5,13,17
CR9
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
6-39
Power Supply, Lithium Ion
Item
No.
0014-00-0225
Description
Reference
46
47
48
49
50
Diode ZNR 1.0W 5% SMD 3.9V
Diode ZNR SMT 5.1V 5% SOT23
Diode ZNR SMT 12.0V 5% SOT23
Diode ZNR 1.0W 5% SMD 18.0V
Diode ZNR SMT 18.0V 5% SOT23
CR14
CR20
CR16,19
CR4
CR8
51
52
53
54
55
Rect UFR 200V 1.0A MUR120 SMT
Rect Schtky SMT 30V 0.3A SOT23
Rect 1xSCH 45V 10A MBR1045
Rect 1xUFR 300V 8A BYT08P300
IC VR +15V 2% 0.5A 78M15 TO220
CR3,6,7,21
CR12,15,22,23,24
CR10
CR11
U5
56
57
58
59
60
IC VR -15V 1% 0.5A 79M15 TO220
IC Volt Detector ICL7665CPA
IC VR SHUNT TL431 2.0% SOP-8
Opto-Coupler TSTR 4N35
Varistor 300VAC 80J
U3
U8
U4
U2
M1
61
62
63
64
65
IC PWM 3844 SO-8
IC PWM 3843 SO-8
IC Batt Charger BQ2000 SOIC
Res F CF 1/4W 5% P 4.7 Ohm
Res F MF 1/4W 1% P 226.00K Ohm
U1
U6,9
U7
R18
R4,21
66
67
68
69
70
Res F MO 2W 5% P 0.10 Ohm
Res F MO 2W 5% P 120.00K Ohm
Res F MO 2W 5% NP 33.00K Ohm
Thermistor NTC 10.0 Ohm 1.7A
Res F MO 1W 5% NP 470.00 Ohm
R22
R2
R16
RT1
R46,59
71
72
73
74
75
Res F MO 1W 5% P 0.47 Ohm
Res F MO 1/4W 5% P 22.00 Ohm
Res F CF 1/4W 5% NP 47.0 Ohm
Res SMT 1.00KOhm 1% 1206
Res SMT 150.00KOhm 1% 1206
R1
R14
R28
R69,70,71,75
R57
76
77
78
79
80
Res SMT 200.00KOhm 1% 1206
Res SMT 221.00 Ohm 1% 1206
Res SMT 27.40 Ohm 1% 1206
Res SMT 365.00KOhm 1% 1206
Res SMT 681.00KOhm 1% 1206
R25,74
R32,83
R36,54
R30,50,62,87
R48,79
81
82
83
84
85
Res F SM 1/3W 5%
1.0K Ohm
Res F SM 1/4W 5% 47.0 Ohm
Res SMT 4.7 Ohm 5% 1206
Res F SM 1/4W .25% 1.24K Ohm
Res SMT 1.00K Ohm 1% 0805
R65,67,68
R84
R53
R9,19,39,40,52
R5,13,31,34,43,78,82,85,88
86
87
88
89
90
Res SMT 1.00K Ohm 1% 0805
Res SMT 10.70K Ohm 1% 0805
Res SMT 113.00K Ohm 1% 0805
Res SMT 124.00 Ohm 1% 0805
Res SMT 13.70K Ohm 1% 0805
R95
R10,23,45,58,63,76,93
R17,47
R90
R7
6-40
Part Number
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
Power Supply, Lithium Ion
Item
No.
Part Number
0014-00-0225
Description
Reference
91
92
93
94
95
Res SMT 1.50K Ohm 1% 0805
Res SMT 16.50K Ohm 1% 0805
Res SMT 17.80K Ohm 1% 0805
Res SMT 221.00 Ohm 1% 0805
Res SMT 2.21K Ohm 1% 0805
R42,96
R37
R72,86
R12,20,92
R26,29
96
97
98
99
100
Res SMT 22.10K Ohm 1% 0805
Res SMT 3.32M Ohm 1% 0805
Res SMT 33.20 Ohm 1% 0805
Res SMT 475.00 Ohm 1% 0805
Res SMT 4.75K Ohm 1% 0805
R15,41
R56
R89
R6,33,35,61,77
R11,55,66,94
101
102
103
104
105
Res SMT 47.50K Ohm 1% 0805
Res SMT 47.50 Ohm 1% 0805
Res SMT 54.90K Ohm 1% 0805
Res SMT 6.19K Ohm 1% 0805
Res SMT 150.00KOhm 0.1% 1206
R24,38,81,91
R3,60,80
R27
R8,51
R49
106
107
108
109
110
Wire Jumper Ins 22GA 0.300"
Wire Jumper Ins 18GA 0.750"
Sleeving Heatshrink BLK 3/4"
Conn Hdr .1 Ctr Locking 14 Pos
Conn Hdr Amp 640445-3
W1
FOR: F3
For: M1
J3
J4
111
112
113
114
115
HEADER-3 POS,.312 CENTERS
NUT,ASSEM LK WASH.,6-32,SM PAT
Screw PnHd 4-40 X .312 Phil
Washer Flt Stl Narrow 0.25 OD
WASHER,SPLIT LOCK, #4
J2
FN11
FN3
FN4
FN2
116
117
118
119
120
Screw UC FLT HD 4-40 .312
Insulator,Nomex,MSP1510
Clamp TO-220 Nylon
Insulator Silpad 0.6" X 0.87"
Screw FH 100 Deg 6-32 X 0.500"
FN12
FN8
FN5
FN6
FN7
121
122
123
124
125
Screw FH 100 Deg 6-32 X 0.625"
Clamp Bar GPFC110
SPRINGCLIP,MOUNTING,TO-220
STANDOFF,SWAGE,4-40 x .250
Insulator Silpad 0.6" X 0.87"
FN10
FN9
FN3
FN4
FN2
126
127
128
129
Fuse Micro Time-Lag 4.00A 250V
Tubing Teflon Clear 20GA
LABEL-BARCODE,MSP1698
CAP AL LO-Z 105C 25V 560MF
F1,2
FOR R59
FN13
C60,C14,C17
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
6-41
Nellcor Interface BD
P/N 0670-00-0675
Item
No
1
Part Number
2
3
4
5
0014-00-0200
POWER SUPPLY, ISOLATED DC/DC CONVERTER, 5V T1
TO 5V
POWER SUPPLY, DC/DC CONVERTER, 1W, +/- 9V
T2
0108-00-0095
0136-00-0201
INDUCTOR, POWER SMD, 22uH
CONNECTOR, TEST POINT
L1
TP1(GND), TP2(+5V), TP3(RX),
TP4(RST*), TP5(TX),
TP6(+5AN), TP8(+5DIG),
TP9(-5AN)
6
7
0136-00-0287-07
0136-85-0010
J2
J1
8
0136-91-0003
9
0136-91-0004
CONNECTOR, RECEPTACLE, DUAL ROW
CONNECTOR, HEADER, SHROUDED RIGHT ANGLE
W/EJECTOR
CONNECTOR, HEADER, RIGHT ANGLE LOCKING
AND POLARIZED
CONNECTOR, HEADER, RIGHT ANGLE LOCKING
AND POLARIZED
0014-00-0047
Description
Reference
J3
J4
10
11
0153-00-0209
12
13
14
15
0155-00-0775
0155-00-0776
0155-00-0791-01
0155-00-1007-01
16
17
0155-00-1007-02
0155-00-1062-01
IC, HCPL2232, OPTOCOUPLER, LOGIC OUTPUT
IC, MAX710, 3.3/5V STEP-UP/DOWN DC/DC CONVERTER
U1
U6
18
19
20
0287-00-1104
0289-00-5475
CAPACITOR, SMD 0805, CERAMIC X7R, 10%, 0.1UF
CAPACITOR, SMD, TANTALUM, 20%, 4.7UF
C1-C3,C6,C9,C11
C7
21
0289-02-3107
C4,C5,C98,C99
22
23
24
25
0289-02-5336
0325-01-1001
0325-01-1002
CAPACITOR, SMD, TANTALUM SWITCH MODE,
100UF
CAPACITOR, SMD, TANTALUM SWITCH MODE, 33UF
RESISTOR, THIN FILM, 1/8W, 1%, 1206, 1K
RESISTOR, THIN FILM, 1/8W, 1%, 1206, 10K
26
27
28
29
30
0361-00-0752
0361-09-0402
0388-00-0675
Support Post, PCB Lock Mount, Nylon
Standoff, Broaching type PCB
PCB, Nellcor Interface Board
31
32
33
34
35
0060-00-0979-01
0060-00-0979-02
0060-00-0979-03
0060-00-0979-05
0060-00-0979-06
Module Specification, Nellcor Interface Board
Design Documentation, Nellcor Interface Board
Worst Case Analysis, Nellcor Interface Board
Design Validation, Nellcor Interface Board
Production Test Specification, Nellcor Interface Board
6-42
Revised 12/20/00
DIODE, MBRS130L, SCHOTTKY POWER RECTIFIER,
30V
IC, +5V REGULATOR, 78L05A
IC, -5V REGULATOR, 79L05A
IC, QUAD, 2 INPUT NAND GATE, 74HCT00
IC, HCPL2212, OPTOCOUPLER, LOGIC OUTPUT
D1-D3
U4
U5
U3
U2
C8,C10
R3-R5, R7
R1,R2, R6
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
Masimo SpO2 Assy
0670-00-0716
Item
No
1
2
Part Number
3
4
5
0108-00-0092
0108-11-0100
6
7
0136-00-0201
0136-00-0299-06
8
9
0136-00-0302
0136-85-0014
10
0136-85-0010
11
0136-91-0004
CONNECTOR PC HEADER RIGHT ANGLE LOCKING
AND POLARIZED
J4
12
13
14
0153-00-0209
CR5, CR6
15
0153-00-0210
DIODE MBRS130LT3 SCHOTTKY POWER RECTIFIER
30V
DIODE MBRS1100 SCHOTTKY POWER RECTIFIER
100V
16
17
0155-00-0791-01
0155-00-0950-02
U3
U5
18
19
20
0155-00-0974-01
0155-00-1007-01
0155-00-1007-02
IC QUAD 2 INPUT NAND GATE 74HCT00
IC SP723 ESD PROTECTION ARRAY 6 CIRCUIT
ENHANCED
IC LT1373 SWITCHING REGULATOR 1.5A
IC HCPL2212 OPTOCOUPLER LOGIC OUTPUT
IC HCPL2232 OPTOCOUPLER LOGIC OUTPUT
21
22
23
24
25
0286-03-2102
0287-00-1103
0287-00-1104
CAPACITOR SMD 1206 CERAMIC 100V 5%, 1000PF
CAPACITOR SMD 0805 CERAMIC X7R 10%, 0.01UF
CAPACITOR SMD 0805 CERAMIC X7R 10%, 0.1UF
C8
C23,C24,C25,C26
C1,C2,C3,C5,C7
26
0289-02-3107
27
0289-02-4476
CAPACITOR SMD TANTALUM SWITCH MODE, 100UF, C6,C17
16V
CAPACITOR SMD TANTALUM SWITCH MODE, 47UF, C18
20V
28
29
0289-02-6106
30
0289-02-6226
31
0289-02-7106
32
33
34
35
0325-01-1001
0325-01-1002
0325-01-4640
0325-01-5111
0014-00-0229
Description
POWER SUPPLY ISOLATED DC/DC CONVERTER 5V
TO 5V
INDUCTOR FIXED, 150UH
INDUCTOR MOLDED SURFACE MOUNT 1812, 10UH
CONNECTOR PC TEST POINT
CONNECTOR SMT PASS-THRU RECEPTACLE .100" x
.100"
CONNECTOR SMT HEADER .100"x .100"
CONNECTOR PC HEADER SHROUDED RIGHT
ANGLE W/EJECTOR
CONNECTOR PC HEADER SHROUDED RIGHT
ANGLE W/EJECTOR
Reference
T1
L1
L2,L3
TP1-TP9
J5
J6
J2
J1
CR3, CR4
U4
U2
U1
CAPACITOR SMD TANTALUM SWITCH MODE, 10UF,
35V
CAPACITOR SMD TANTALUM SWITCH MODE, 22UF,
35V
C12,C13
CAPACITOR SMD TANTALUM SWITCH MODE, 10UF,
50V
RESISTOR THIN FILM 1/8W 1.0% 1206, 1K
RESISTOR THIN FILM 1/8W 1.0% 1206, 10K
RESISTOR THIN FILM 1/8W 1.0% 1206, 464
RESISTOR THIN FILM 1/8W 1.0% 1206, 5.11K
C16
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
C14,C15
R3-R5,R8
R1,R2,R6,R9
R11
R10
Revised 12/20/00
6-43
Masimo SpO2 Assy
Item
No
36
37
38
39
Part Number
0361-09-0402
0388-00-0716
REV 2
0361-32-0312
STANDOFF, BROACHING TYPE PCB
PCB, MASIMO INTERFACE BD
41
42
43
44
0220-22-0440
0361-32-0500
NUT, HEX, NYLON, STANDARD, #4-40
STANDOFF, HEX, M/F, NYLON, #4-40, 1/2
0060-00-1075-01
45
0060-00-1075-02
MODULE SPECIFICATION, MASIMO INTERFACE
BOARD
DESIGN SPECIFICATION, MASIMO INTERFACE
BOARD
46
0060-00-1075-03
47
48
0060-00-1075-05
0060-00-1075-06
40
6-44
0670-00-0716
Description
Reference
STANDOFF, HEX, M/F, NYLON, #4-40, 5/16
WORST CASE ANALYSIS, MASIMO INTERFACE
BOARD
DESIGN VALIDATION, MASIMO INTERFACE BOARD
PRODUCTION TEST SPECIFICATION, MASIMO INTERFACE BOARD
Revised 12/20/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
Tone Processor Module
Item
No.
Part Number
1
2
3
4
0008-01-0003
0008-01-0006
0108-00-0067
0136-21-0008
5
0136-92-0003
6
0155-00-2127
7
8
9
10
Description
TUBING HEAT SHRINK 062 ID,
TUBING HEAT SHRINK 250 ID,
FERRITE BEAD SMD
CONNECTOR PC HEADER RIGHT ANGLE
SINGLE ROW .100 PITCH
CONN PC HDR STR LKG PLZD 3 CKT,
IC AUDIO POWER AMPLIFIER WITH SHUTDOWN MODE
0155-00-0875-02 IC AD7528 DUAL 8 BIT MULTIPLYING DAC
0155-00-1010-01 IC OPA2336 OPERATIONAL AMPLIFIER
0155-00-1040-02 IC DS1811 ECONORESET WITH OPEN DRAIN
OUTPUT
0158-05-0011
CRYSTAL CLOCK OSCILLATOR W/TRISTATE,
3.69MHZ
11
0287-00-2102
12
0287-01-2103
13
0287-01-2104
14
0287-02-1105
15
0670-00-1134
Reference
L1-L3
J4
U4
U2
U5
U3
Y1
0289-01-4106
CAPACITOR SMD 0805 CERAMIC X7R 5%,
0.001UF
CAPACITOR SMD 1206 CERAMIC X7R 5%,
0.01UF
CAPACITOR SMD 1206 CERAMIC X7R 5%,
0.1UF
CAPACITOR SMD 1825 CERAMIC X7R 10%,
1UF
CAPACITOR SMD ELECTROLYTIC 20%, 10UF
C2
16
17
18
19
20
0324-01-1000
0325-02-3002
0326-01-1001
0326-01-1002
0326-01-1502
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM 1/4W 1%, 100
RESISTOR THIN FILM 1/8W 0.1% 1206, 30.0K
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM 1/10W 1%, 1K
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM 1/10W 1%, 10K
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM 1/10W 1%, 15K
R2,R19
R7
R3,R6
R1,R4,R5,R8,R10,R21,R23,R26,R27,R34
R25
21
22
23
24
25
0326-01-2002
0326-01-3321
0326-01-33R2
0388-00-1134
1308-403-422
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM 1/10W 1%, 20K
R24
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM 1/10W 1%, 3.32K R32
RESISTOR SMD THICK FILM 1/10W 1%, 33.2
R9,R11-R18,R20
PCB TONE PROCESSOR,
CONN HOUSING METHODE 1308-403-422,
26
27
28
29
30
7560-05
0155-90-0419
0060-00-1115-01
0060-00-1115-02
0060-00-1115-03
CABLE 22 AWG 5 COND MOLEX 7560-05,
MICROCONTROLLER
MODULE SPECIFICATION DOCUMENT
DESIGN SPECIFICATION DOCUMENT
WORST CASE ANALYSIS DOCUMENT
31
32
0060-00-1115-05 TEST PROTOCOL DOCUMENT
0060-00-1115-06 TEST SPECIFICATION
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
C9
C12,C17,C21,C22
C1,C4-C6,C8,C13-C16,C23
C3,C7
U1
Added 12/20/00
6-45
This page intentionally left blank.
6-46
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 6 - Parts
7.0 CALIBRATION
CONTENTS OF THIS CHAPTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Page
Diagnostic Menu Table. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2
7.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3
7.2 Warnings and Guidelines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3
7.3 Test Equipment and Special Tools Required. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3
7.4 Power-Up Sequence, Internal Testing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
7.5 Service Diagnostics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
7.5.1 Introduction (Hidden Key) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
7.5.2 Software Version Test (0a, 0b, 0c, 0d) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-5
7.5.3 Keypad Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6
7.5.4 LED Test (2a, 2b) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-7
7.5.5 Communications Test (3a, 3b) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-7
7.5.6 Recorder Test (4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-7
7.5.6.1 Recorder Print Head Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8
7.5.7 Pump Test (5). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8
7.5.8 Leak Test (7) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9
7.5.9 Over Pressure Test (8a, 8b, 8c) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9
7.5.10 Pulse Channel DC Offset Test (9a, 9b, 9c) . . . . . . . . . . 7-10
7.5.11 Pulse Channel Average Noise Test (10a, 10b, 10c) . . . . 7-10
7.5.12 Main Pressure Transducer Verification Test
(11a, 11b, 11c) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11
7.5.13 Verification of Accutorr Plus Pneumatic Performance,
Using the “Cufflink” NIBP Emulator (11d) . . . . . . . . . 7-11
7.5.14 Over Pressure Transducer Verification (12c, 12a, 12b) . 7-12
7.5.15 Main Pressure Transducer Calibration. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-12
7.5.16 Over Pressure Transducer Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-13
7.5.17 Battery Selection (13) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-13
7.6 Predictive Thermometer Verification and Calibration. . . . . . . . . . 7-14
7.6.1 Temperature Accuracy Verification with the Predictive
Temperature simulator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-14
7.6.2 Water Bath Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-15
7.6.3 System Calibration Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-15
7.6.4 Temperature Verification Test, Infrared Thermometer . . . . 7-16
7.6.5 Low Battery Sensing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-17
7.7 Battery Test for Accutorr Plus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-18
7.7.1 Low Battery Indicator and Low Battery Cut-Off . . . . . . . . . 7-18
7.7.2 Set the Current Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-19
7.8 NIBP Normal Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-20
7.9 Trend Memory Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-21
7.10 SpO2 Normal Operation (Accutorr Plus with SpO2 only) . . . . . . . 7-21
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 7 - Calibration
Revised 9/20/07
7-1
Status and Error Code Table
The Accutorr Plus uses the various displays on the front panel to display the operational
status. Error codes listed below can generally be resolved by the user however, error codes
with an asterisk (*) may require resolution by a qualified technical service person.
TYPE
NIBP
TEMP
(PTM)
SpO2
CODE DESCRIPTION
8810 Retry - Unable to
Measure
8811 Retry - Pump
Higher
8812 Stop - Cuff
Overpressure
8813 Stop - Unable to
Measure
8830 Check Probe
8831 Replace Probe
8832 Battery Low
8850 No Sensor
8851 Sensor Off
8852
8853
8854
8855
8856
8857
8857
8857
8858
8858
8858
SYSTEM 984*
985*
986*
987*
988*
990*
991*
995*
996*
REASON
Motion artifact, cycle time-out, weak pulsations or no pulsations. A triple beep tone is generated.
Insufficient cuff pressure. A triple beep tone is generated.
Excessive cuff pressure detected by the software. A triple beep
tone is generated.
4 successive measurement attempts failed. A triple beep tone is
generated.
Tissue contact may have been lost.
Defective probe or connection.
The 9V battery needs replacement.
No sensor connected.
Sensor not on patient.
(Datascope and Masimo SpO2 only)
Interference
Interference on signal.
(Datascope and Masimo SpO2 only)
Pulse Search
Unit cannot find signal. (Nellcor SpO2 Module will report
“Pulse Search” -8853- when the sensor is not on the patient.)
Weak Pulse
Weak pulse detected.
(Datascope and Masimo SpO2 only)
No Pulse
No pulse detected. (Datascope SpO2 only)
Check Sensor
Sensor problem.
(Datascope and Masimo SpO2 only)
PR<30
Pulse rate is less than 30 bpm. (Datascope SpO2 only)
PR<21
Pulse rate is less than 21 bpm. (Nellcor SpO2 only)
PR<26
Pulse rate is less than 26 bpm. (Masimo SpO2 only)
PR>249
Pulse rate is greater than 249 bpm. (Nellcor SpO2 only)
PR>239
Pulse rate is greater than 239 bpm. (Masimo SpO2 only)
PR>250
Pulse rate is greater than 250 bpm. (Datascope SpO2 only)
NIBP Hardware Failure NIBP A/D failure detected.
The overpressure circuit is not set to the current patient size.
NIBP Overpressure
Circuit not
Programmed
NIBP Overpressure
The two pressure transducers are not tracking each other.
Circuit not Tracking
Stop - Hardware
Excessive cuff pressure detected by hardware over-pressure senOverpressure
sor. A triple beep tone is generated.
TEMP Bad Calibration Thermometer needs calibration.
TEMP Illegal Mode
Thermometer switch is set wrong.
TEMP Module Failed Thermometer internal failure.
SpO2 Uncalibrated
SpO2 fails calibration check.
SpO2 Failure
SpO2 failed self-test.
Table 7-1 - Error Codes
7-2
Revised 2/15/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 7 - Calibration
7.1 INTRODUCTION
The Accutorr Plus is a state of the art device employing digital determination and
verification systems to obtain superior performance for the life of the product. Most function
calibration constants are written into the operating software, therefore, for the most part,
there are no means to calibrate or adjust system functions. The instrument contains
extensive Service Diagnostics that will, in most cases, isolate a malfunction to the lowest
serviceable module.
NOTE: This procedure refers to this instrument as the UUT (Unit Under Test).
All internal verifications and adjustments should be performed with the internal battery
disconnected. Operate the UUT on the main power supply. This will insure a reliable
power source for the test, as well as providing a measure of safety in case of accidental
overload of the power source. To re-initialize the low battery detector circuits, reconnect
the battery at the conclusion of all tests while the UUT is on A.C. power source. Reset
the real time clock and date, if required.
7.2 WARNINGS AND GUIDELINES
In the event that the instrument covers are removed, observe these following warnings
and general guidelines:
Do not short component leads together.
Perform all steps in the exact order given.
Use extreme care when reaching inside the opened instrument. Do not contact
exposed metal parts which may become live.
Read through each step in the procedure so it is understood prior to beginning
the step.
7.3 TEST EQUIPMENT AND SPECIAL TOOLS REQUIRED
(Equipment types other than these listed may be utilized if they perform the required
functions)
Dynatech Nevada Non-Invasive Blood Pressure Simulator (Cuff Link)
Power Supply - Power-Mate, 3A 20V
Fluke DVM - Model 8050A
Digital Storage Scope - Tektronix, 2230 100MHZ
Stop Watch - Wilson LW #19
SpO2 Simulator - Biotek “Index”
RS232 Test Connector (pins 2 and 3 shorted) - 9 pin male “D”
700cc Dummy Cuff - 0138-00-0001-01
Chart Paper - 0683-00-0300-01
Water Bath - Cole-Palmer, model H-12-105-10
Reference Quartz Thermometer - Hewlet-Packard model HP-2804A with Temp.
Probe HP-1811A
Predictive Thermometer Simulator - 0454-00-0017*
*NOTE: Not approved for sale to customers in CE countries.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 7 - Calibration
7-3
7.4 POWER-UP SEQUENCE, INTERNAL TESTING
1. Attach the AC power cord into the UUT rear panel AC Input Module.
2. Press the On/Standby key to turn the UUT On. The UUT automatically performs
internal self diagnostics. Verify that all the LED’s (Light Emitting Diodes) display a
series of scrolling LED tests. After the initial power up sequence an “a” is displayed
in the bed LED, a “0" is displayed in the Room LED’s and ”ddd" is displayed in the
Systolic LED’s.
3. Press the On/Standby key to turn the UUT off.
7.5 SERVICE DIAGNOSTICS
The Service Diagnostics tests must be run in the sequence indicated. Not following
the tests in the order shown may result in the test failing. The numbers and letters in
parentheses after the title of each test, represent the room number and bed letter used to
access the test.
7.5.1 Introduction (Hidden Key)
To enter the Service Diagnostics mode, while powering on the unit, press and hold the
hidden key until two beeps are heard. The hidden key is the Adult symbol above the
Patient Setup key.
Verify that after the initial power up sequence a “0" is displayed in the Room LED, ”a" is
displayed in the Bed LED, and “ddd” is displayed in the Systolic LED’s.
7-4
Revised 10/29/99
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 7 - Calibration
7.5.2 Software Version Test (0a, 0b)
This test displays the installed software
version (s) in the monitor. The results are
displayed in the read outs illustrated in
figure 7-1.
START
NIBP
PATIENT
SETUP
Installed Software
Version ie: "A01.02"
DEFLATE
INTERVAL
DIA.
TIMER/TEMP
MAP
INTERVAL ELAP. TIME TEMP
ALARMS
SET
ALARMS
MUTE
Sp02
NIBP
Software Module
Selection
DATA
SCAN
ROOM
ie: "ACM Runtime
software identifier"
Press ROOM/BED key to select BED.
Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select
test “a” or “b”. Monitors without
SpO2 option may not display results for
tests “0c” and “0d”. Press ROOM/BED
again to lock in selection.
ROOM
BED
PATIENT INFO.
SpO2
BED
DELETE
INFO.
MEMORY FULL
MENU
SELECT
PRINT
DEFAULTS
+ -
Confirm that the ROOM number is at
“0"; otherwise use the ”ROOM/BED"
key to select the “ROOM”, and the
Up/Down keys to set Room number
to “0".
NIBP
SYS.
HOLD TO CLEAR.
ON/
STANDBY
Figure 7-1 Software Version Test
Press the START NIBP key.
Press the DEFLATE key until a beep
is heard. This allows a selection of the
next test.
Repeat process for test “b”.
Description of Software Module
ACM Runtime Software Version
ACM Boot Software Version
SpO2 ACM Runtime Software Version
SpO2 ACM Boot Software Version
Test
Room Number
0
0
0
0
Sub Test
Patient Bed Letter
a
b
c*
d*
Table 7-2
NOTE: Monitors with Nellcor® and Masimo® SpO2 do not report SpO2 Runtime and
Boot Software Versions.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 7 - Calibration
Revised 2/15/00
7-5
7.5.3 Keypad Test
1. Press the Room Up arrow to change the Room Number to “1"
2. Press the Start NIBP key to run the keypad test.
3. Press any key on the keyboard. A number will appear in the Patient Bed Letter
Display. This number is identified in the figure 7-2. Verify that the correct number
appears in the Patient Bed Letter Display when each key is pressed.
Hidden Key,
Start Test
Key 0
Key #
NIBP
SYS.
PATIEN T
SETUP
DIA.
START
N IBP
9
DEFLATE
1
INTERVAL
11
17
TIMER/TEMP
5
MAP
INTERVAL ELAP. TIME TEMP
NIBP
4
ALA RMS
SET
ALARMS
MU TE
Sp02
19
16
13
DATA
SCA N
ROOM
Key Test Display
MEN U
SELEC T
DELETE
IN FO.
M E M ORY FULL
S/D/M
114/64 83
123/61 84
127/62 83
185/105135
129/62 84
03:00
02:58
02:35
02:33
02:30
BED
PR INT
HOLD TO CLEAR.
10
o
F/C %SPO2
61 98.7 96
60 98.5 97
58 97.6 96
96
56 ---59 98.2 97
DEFAULTS
+ -
20/05
20/05
20/05
20/05
20/05
ROOM
BED
PATIENT INFO.
SpO2
8
18
ON/
STAND BY
ON / Off
22
12
20
14
2
7
Keyboard Test,
Accutorr Plus with Trend
and SpO2
Figure 7-2
4. Press the Deflate key for 3 seconds to exit keypad test.
7-6
Revised 09/02/99
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 7 - Calibration
7.5.4 LED Test (2a, 2b)
This test allows the LED function to be verified by driving all seven LEDs with numbers
from 0 to 9, in sequential order. For this test, all annunciator LEDs turn on for 1 second.
Test Description
7 Segment LED Test
Annunciator LED Test
Test Room Number
2
2
Sub Test Patient Bed Letter
a
b
Table 7-3
7.5.5 Communications Test (3a, 3b)
This test checks the integrity of the external communications systems. Test 3a checks the
external RS232 interface and requires that the transmit and receive pins be connected
together. Test 3b checks the Datascope Download port and requires that the tip
(transmit) and ring (receive) pins be connected together. The CRC table is transmitted
and received. If the CRC data received matches the CRC table transmitted, the test
passes; otherwise a failure is reported.
Test Description
RS232 Port Test
Download Port Test
Short Connector
Pins
Transmit (2) and
Receive (3)
Tip and Ring
Test Room Number Sub Test Patient Bed
Letter
3
a
3
b
Table 7-4
7.5.6 Recorder Test (4)
1. Select Room Number 4 and press the NIBP Start key to activate the test.
This test prints out a pattern on the recorder if a recorder module is attached. A strip
similar to figure 7-3 will be printed.
Figure 7-3
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 7 - Calibration
7-7
7.5.6.1 Recorder Print Head Adjustment
NOTE: This test and adjustment is performed only after a new printhead is installed.
1. Disconnect the printhead ribbon cable from the connector.
2. Check the oscillator frequency at TP-1 on the recorder control board. Proper frequency
selection is determined by the printhead sensitivity. (The sensitivity rank is marked
on the bottom side of the printhead flex cable, near the 90É bend in the cable.) See
table 7-5.
Print Head Rank
A
B
C
Oscillator Output (KHz)
Minimum
Maximum
9.7
10.9
10.5
12.1
11.6
13.4
Table 7-5
3. Adjust R-1 to the correct frequency. PRECAUTION: Increasing printhead
operating frequency beyond the specified limits will shorten the printhead life or result
in immediate permanent damage.
4. Reconnect the printhead ribbon cable, and run a test strip to confirm proper print
density. The print density is equally dependent on the printhead temperature, as well
as on the sensitivity of the chart paper used. We recommend that the standard
Datascope chart paper for this printer be used for the print test.
7.5.7 Pump Test (5)
Select Room Number 5 and press NIBP Start key to activate the test.
This test evaluates the ability of the pump to pressurize a fixed volume representative of an adult cuff to a typical adult pressure.
A fixed volume of 700 cc is pumped to a pressure of 300 mmHg. While the pump
is operational, the elapsed time is displayed in the Timer/Temperature
display. When the target pressure is reached, the elapsed time display holds its
current reading and the pump deflates the chamber for another test. The test
passes if the chamber is inflated in less than 35 seconds. Pressing the deflate key
at any time during the test causes the NIBP module to open all valves and ends
the test. Pressing and holding the deflate key for three (3) seconds clears the MAP
display and exits the test.
Bleed Rate Test (6a, 6b)
Press the NIBP Start key to activate the selected test. See table 7-6.
This test evaluates the ability of the instrument to maintain a constant bleed rate, for
the purpose of accurate and repeatable NIBP measurements. This test also evaluates
the ability of the system to reduce cuff pressure quickly.
7-8
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 7 - Calibration
A fixed volume of 700 cc is pumped to approximately 20 mmHg over the specified start
pressure (see table 7-6), then vented to atmosphere through one of two different valves.
During the test, the MAP display indicates the real-time system pressure and the
Timer/Temperature display indicates the elapsed time in seconds. When the stop
pressure is reached, the MAP display is blanked and the elapsed time displays the current
reading. Pressing the Deflate key ends the test and deflates the chamber. Pressing and
holding the Deflate key for three seconds clears the MAP display and exits the test. Each
test is uniquely identified in the Patient Bed Letter Display as described in Table 7-6.
The table identifies each test, the corresponding start and stop pressures and required
completion times.
Test Description
Linear Bleed Valve
Test
Dump Valve Test
Start
Pressure
(mmHg)
180
Stop
Pressure
(mmHg)
60
250
20
Time
(Sec.)
15-25
seconds
14 seconds
max.
Test
Room
Number
6
Sub Test Patient
Bed Letter
6
b
a
Table 7-6
7.5.8
Leak Test (7)
Select Room Number 7 and press the NIBP Start key to activate the test.
This test evaluates the ability of the system to maintain a steady pressure.
A fixed volume is pumped up to an initial differential pressure of approximately 250
mmHg and monitored for a fixed period of time. While the pump is operational, peak
pressure is displayed in the MAP display. When the target pump pressure is reached, the
peak pressure is frozen in the MAP display during a five second dwell. During leakage
measurement, the current pressure leakage is displayed in the MAP display and the
elapsed test time (in seconds) is displayed in the Temperature/Time/Interval display.
After the leakage measurement time has elapsed, the MAP and
Temperature/Time/Interval displays are blanked and a “00” (Pass) or “FF” (Fail) will be
displayed in the Bed window. Pressing the Deflate key at any time during the test causes
the NIBP module to open all valves and ends the test. The maximum pressure drop shall
be no more than 10 mmHg in any 90 second period when connected to a 700 cc volume.
Pressing the Deflate key ends the test and deflates the chamber.
Pressing and holding the Deflate key for three seconds clears the MAP display and exits
the test.
7.5.9
Over Pressure Test (8a, 8b, 8c)
Select Room Number and Bed Letter per table 7-7. Press the NIBP Start key to activate
the test.
This test evaluates the ability of the system to prevent an over pressure condition,
independent of software control, for each of 3 over pressure settings. A fixed volume of
700 cc’s is pumped to a target pressure that is above the maximum over pressure specified
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 7 - Calibration
Revised 9/20/07
7-9
for the respective over pressure limit (see table 7-7), while displaying the real-time
system pressure in the MAP display. For this test, the software over pressure monitor is
disabled. On completion, the MAP display indicates the maximum pressure reached and
the Patient Bed Letter Display indicates if the over pressure sensor was activated (00) or
not (FF). Pressing the Deflate key at any time during the test causes the NIBP module to
open all valves and ends the test.
Following each over-pressure hardware test, the UUT must be turned off in order to
re-enable the pump.
Test Size/Mode
Low
Medium
High
Target Pump
Pressure (mmHg)
157, ±5
210, ±10
315, ±15
Test Room Number
8
8
8
Sub Test Patient
Bed Letter
a
b
c
Table 7-7
7.5.10
Pulse Channel DC Offset Test (9a, 9b, 9c)
Select Room Number and Bed Letter per table 7-8, and press the NIBP Start key to
activate the test.
This test measures the DC offset for each of the three electronic gain settings available on
the pulse channel. Results for each gain setting are displayed in the Timer/Temperature
display (in Volts). Table 7-8 describes the tests performed.
Test Description
Gain 1 (Low) Test
Gain 2 (Med) Test
Gain 3 (High) Test
Acceptable
Limit (V)
1.50 to 1.83
1.50 to 1.83
1.50 to 1.83
Test Room Number
9
9
9
Sub Test Patient
Bed Letter
a
b
c
Table 7-8
7.5.11
Pulse Channel Average Noise Test (10a, 10b, 10c)
Select Room Number and Bed Letter per table 7-9, and press the NIBP Start key to
activate the test.
This test measures the average noise for each of three electronic gain settings available on
the pulse channel. Results for each gain setting are displayed in the Timer/Temperature
display (in millivolts). Table 7-9 describes the tests performed.
Test Description
Gain 1 (Low) Test
Gain 2 (Med) Test
Gain 3 (High) Test
Acceptable
Limit (mV)
<25
<50
<75
Test Room Number Sub Test Patient
Bed Letter
a
10
b
10
10
c
Table 7-9
7-10
Revised 9/20/07
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 7 - Calibration
7.5.12
Main Pressure Transducer Verification Test (11a, 11b, 11c)
This tests the calibration of the main pressure transducer in LOW, MED, and HIGH
modes. This is done by comparing the readings of the UUT to an external pressure gauge
in LOW mode below 100 mmHg, in MED mode between 100 mmHg to 200 mmHg,
and in HIGH mode between 200 mmHg to 300 mmHg. In the event of a disagreement
between the device and an external gauge, the transducer must be calibrated by
performing the calibration in section 7.5.15 Main Pressure Transducer Calibration.
1. Select diagnostic test “11” (Room) “a” (Bed).
2. Press the Start NIBP key to start LOW calibration test. Verify that the pump comes
on, the pressure increases, and then the pump stops. After 10 seconds, verify that the
pressure settles below 100 mmHg. Compare the final pressure displayed to an accurate (±0.2%) external pressure gauge. The MAP LEDs reading should agree within
±1% with the external pressure gauge. If it does not agree, a failure has occurred and
proceed to 7.5.15 Main Pressure Transducer Calibration.
3. Press the Deflate key to release the pressure and exit the test.
4. Select diagnostic test “11” (Room) “b” (Bed).
5. Press the Start NIBP key to start the MED calibration test. Verify that the pump comes on, the pressure increases and then the pump stops. After 10 seconds verify that
the pressure settles between 100 mmHg and 200 mmHg. Compare the pressure displayed to an accurate (±0.2%) external pressure gauge. The pressure MAP LEDs reading should agree within ±1% with the external pressure gauge. If it does not agree, a
failure has occurred and proceed to 7.5.15 Main Pressure Transducer Calibration.
6. Press the Deflate key to release the pressure and exit the test.
7. Select diagnostic test “11” (Room) “c” (Bed).
8. Press the Start NIBP key to start HIGH calibration test. Verify that the pump comes
on, the pressure increases, and then the pump stops. After 10 seconds, verify that the
pressure settles between 200 mmHg and 300 mmHg. Compare the final pressure displayed to an accurate (±0.2%) external pressure gauge; the MAP LEDs reading should
agree within ±1% with the external pressure gauge. If it does not agree, a failure has
occurred and proceed to 7.5.15 Main Pressure Transducer Calibration.
9. Press the Deflate key to release pressure and exit the test.
7.5.13
Verification of Accutorr Plus Pneumatic Performance, using the
“Cufflink” NIBP Simulator (11d)
Select Room Number 11 and Bed Letter d, and press the NIBP Start key to activate the test.
For these tests, program the Cufflink NIBP simulator to perform the desired test. Instead
of pumping up the cuff, this test uses the Cufflink simulator to verify the Accutorr
pressure reading for the NIBP Leak Test, Over Pressure test, and the Main Pressure
Transducer Verification Test. The Accutorr displays the pressure in the MAP display.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 7 - Calibration
Revised 9/20/07
7-11
Pressing the Deflate key at any time during the test causes the NIBP module to open all
valves and ends the test. Pressing and holding the Deflate key for three seconds clears the
MAP display and exits test. The Cufflink simulator must be exited separately.
NOTE: The reading and setting accuracy will be dependent on the accuracy of the
Cufflink calibration and the Accutorr Plus condition.
The Cufflink standard dynamic pressure simulation may produce Systolic / Mean /
Diastolic read outs on the Accutorr Plus outside of the specified limits. The pressure
simulation results may not be accepted as a measure of the Accutorr Plus clinical
performance.
7.5.14
Over Pressure Transducer Verification (12c, 12a, 12b)
This test verifies that the over-pressure transducer is calibrated correctly. Calibration is
checked in the Low level pressure mode so that the limit displayed in the MAP window
should say 158 mmHg (±1). If it does not, the transducer needs to calibrated by
proceeding to 7.5.16 Over-pressure Transducer Calibration. The over-pressure transducer
should also be verified in the High and Mid level pressure modes.
1. Select diagnostic test “12” (Room) “a” (Bed). Low Limit
2. Press the Start NIBP key to start the test.
3. Verify that the over-pressure value displayed in the MAP LEDs is 158 mmHg (±1).
4. Repeat steps 1 through 3, but select test “12” “c” to check over-pressure limit, 315
mmHg (±15); and test “12” “b” for Mid level over-pressure limit, 210 mmHg (±10).
5. Press the Deflate key to exit this test.
7.5.15
Main Pressure Transducer Calibration
NOTE: This procedure should only be performed in the event that there was a failure in
7.5.12 Main Pressure Transducer Verification.
This is the procedure for calibrating the main pressure transducer in the event that there
is a disagreement between the UUT and the external pressure gauge in the proceeding
test. The device is calibrated by comparison with the Cufflink simulator at 158 mmHg
(±1) and then by adjusting R40 on the 0670-00-0584-01 PCB.
1. Connect the Cufflink simulator to the Accutorr Plus cuff connector, and connect a
700 cc test chamber to the open port of the simulator. Select the manometer function
of the simulator.
2. Select diagnostic test “11” (Room) “d” (Bed).
3. Press the Start NIBP Key to start HIGH calibration procedure.
7-12
Revised 9/20/07
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 7 - Calibration
4. Pump up the Cufflink simulator to 158 ±1mmHg.
5. Allow pressure to stabilize for 10 seconds. Read the pressure in the MAP display.
6. Adjust R40 on the 0670-00-0584-01 PCB until the MAP readout is the same as the
simulator’s manometer reading.
7. Press the Deflate key to exit this test.
8. Repeat 7.5.12 Main Pressure Transducer Verification.
7.5.16
Over Pressure Transducer Calibration
NOTE: This procedure should only be performed if a failure occurred in steps 1 through
3 of 7.5.14 Over-Pressure Transducer Verification.
This is the procedure for calibrating the over-pressure transducer in the event that the
display does not read 158 mmHg during the test for Low pressure mode in 7.5.14 Over
Pressure Transducer Verification. The transducer is calibrated using R4,on the
0670-00-0584-01 PCB.
1. Adjust R4, on the 0670-00-0584-01 PCB until MAP read out is 158 mmHg.
2. Repeat 7.5.14 Over Pressure Transducer Verification.
7.5.17
Battery Selection (13)
This section will allow the user to configure the unit for a Sealed Lead Acid or Lithium
Ion battery.
1. Select diagnostic test (Room) “13”.
2. Press the Start NIBP to enable the selection process. The pump will NOT start up.
3. The Diastolic display will show the currently configured battery type. Sealed Lead
Acid will be represented by “La” and Lithium Ion will be represented by “Li”.
4. Using the Patient Info Up/Down arrow keys, select the appropriate battery type.
5. Press the Deflate key to confirm your choice. If the Deflate key is not pressed, the
change will not take effect.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 7 - Calibration
Revised 9/20/07
7-13
7.6 PREDICTIVE THERMOMETER VERIFICATION AND
CALIBRATION
The first, Temperature Accuracy Verification with the Predictive Temperature Simulator, is a very quick method to confirm that the PTM is operating within the specified
limits. The PTM simulator is a Datascope proprietary test device, available for purchase
from the company. The Predictive Temperature Simulator (P/N 0454-00-0017) has not
been released for sale to customers in CE countries.
The second method, called the Water Bath Method, utilizes laboratory grade stirred
water bath to confirm that the PTM is operating within the specified limits.
In case of failure or inaccuracy of readings, the System Calibration Procedure may be
followed to re-adjust the device to factory specifications.
This procedure requires high accuracy test equipment and therefore it is not recommended
for field calibration. Datascope offers a comprehensive factory service program to support
this product."
7.6.1 Temperature Accuracy Verification with the Predictive Temperature
Simulator
1. Measure the battery in the Predictive Thermometer module, verify that the voltage is
8.6 V or greater. NOTE: Newer modules do not contain a 9V battery. Skip this step.
2. Install the Predictive Temperature Module onto the Accutorr Plus and turn on the
monitor.
3. Remove the temperature probe from the probe holder and disconnect the connector
from the Predictive Thermometer module. Connect the Predictive Temperature
Simulator.
4. Select 85.0 ° F (29.4 ° C) and push the “Push to cycle PTM” button to reset the PTM.
5. Note the resultant display in the TIMER/TEMP window on the Accutorr Plus. It
should be 85.0 ° F (29.4 ° C).
6. Press the “Push to cycle PTM”. Select the next higher temperature, 98.5 ° F (37.0 ° C).
Since this is a predictive device with “look ahead” algorithm, it is important to read
only the second number flashed on the display. The first, third or subsequent
flashing readings may be outside of the limits. Return to 85.0 ° F (29.4 ° C).
7. Repeat step 6 for the remaining temperatures. Record the test results. All readings
must be within 0.1 (F/C) degrees of simulator settings.
8. Disconnect the Predictive Temperature Simulator, and connect the normal temperature
probe. Insert, then remove the probe from the probe holder. This will reset the PTM,
and flash an initial value of 85.0 ° F or 29.4 ° C.
7-14
Revised 01/11/00
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 7 - Calibration
7.6.2 Water Bath Method
1. Prepare a water bath set to 89.6 to 110.0° F as a temperature reference. Confirm
temperature with a separate precision thermometer.
2. Snap a protective sheath onto the temperature probe, and immerse into the reference
water bath for 30 seconds, or until the temperature display stops flashing. Record the
temperature shown on the temperature display.
3. Apply the correction factor, shown in table 7-13, to obtain the calibrated measurement.
Celsius Readouts
Range
Subtract
32.0 to 41.0
0.6
41.0 to 43.0
0.5
Fahrenheit Readouts
Range
Subtract
89.6 to 102.0
1.1
102.1 to 106.0
1.0
106.0 to 110.0
.5
Table 7-13
4. Compare readouts after correction factors are calculated. Proceed to System Calibration
Procedure if readings are out of specification.
7.6.3 System Calibration Procedure
1. Connect a fresh 9 volt battery or an external power supply set to 9æ .1V to the
predictive thermometer. NOTE: Newer modules do not contain a 9V battery. Skip
this step.
2. Set SW2-3 to closed position (the switch is towards the PCB). Connect resistor decade
box to the temperature probe connector. Set the decade box to 8343 ohms, ± 2 ohms.
NOTE: (All other settings of SW2 should be in the open position; away from the PCB.)
3. Connect the DVM to J4-2 (-) and J4-7 (+) output jacks.
4. Jumper J4-2 and ground terminal ( J2-1) jacks.
5. Switch power supply on.
6. Adjust R1 until a reading of 100 mV, ± 5 mV is on the DVM.
7. Adjust the decade box to 4746 ohms, ± 2 ohms. Record the voltage displayed on the
DVM.
8. Connect the DVM + lead to J4-4. Adjust R2 until the DVM reading is the same as
the one recorded in step “7”, ± 1mV.
9. Remove all jumpers and test leads. The calibration is completed.
10. Set the decade box back to 8343 ohms. Power cycle the unit (switch off then on).
The initial start-up temperature of 85.0oF should be displayed.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 7 - Calibration
Revised 01/11/00
7-15
7.6.4 Temperature Verification Test, Infrared Thermometer (applicable only to
units equipped with a temperature option)
1. Pre-heat water bath to 100° F. Place floating Black Body device into water bath and
allow to stabilize until step 7, or a minimum of 30 seconds.
2. Prepare the thermometer for the verification process, by removing any disposable
probe covers. Clean the probe lens with a swab dipped in alcohol.
3. Completely cover probe tip with a piece of aluminum foil, from the lens to the probe
neck portion. Allow 5 minutes for the probe and foil to stabilize at ambient temperature.
4. Activate the thermometer, by pressing the button. Read the ambient temperature
displayed and record the number as TA=____.
5. Remove the aluminum foil.
6. Check the water bath temperature against a laboratory grade mercury thermometer,
with a verified accuracy of 0.4 ° F (0.2 ° C) or better. Record the water bath temperature as
TT=____.
7. Attach a disposable probe cover to the thermometer head. Insert the head into the
floating Black Body cavity, such that the instrument is looking into the needle shaped
end.
8. Press the button to measure the temperature. Record the temperature as
TDCALC=____.
9. Select the appropriate correction factor from the following choices:
Core temperature correction: Kcore=1.087
Oral temperature correction: Kora=1.058
Rectal temperature correction: Krectal=1.095
The standard Datascope infrared thermometer is calibrated to indicate Core
temperature, thus the correction factor to be used is K=1.087.
10.Calculate the display temperature according to the following formula:
K(TT-TA)+ TA = Tdcalc where:
Tdcalc is Calculated Display Temperature.
Kcore=1.087 Correction Factor for Core Temperature.
TT is Target Temperature.
TA is Ambient Temperature.
Sample Calculation:
7-16
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 7 - Calibration
Ambient temperature (TA) measured: 72 ° F
Water Bath temperature (TT) measured: 98.6 ° F
Correction Factor (Kcore)=1.087
1.087 (98.6-72) + 72= 100.9 ° F thus,
Temperature displayed by thermometer is 100.9 ° F, and calculated temperature is
100.9 ° F, the accuracy has been verified.
Temperature value deviations: The calculated value is a function of the accuracy of the
water bath temperature. As an example, a ± 1% reading error of water temperature will
result in a ± 1 ° F reading input into the formula, resulting in a final calculated values of
99.9 to 101.9 ° F.
With a display resolution of ± 1 digit and an over all resolution of ± 0.2 ° F, the final,
calculated reading may fall between 98.6 and 102.2 .
7.6.5 Low Battery Sensing
The low battery threshold is not adjustable. When the battery has reached the low
battery threshold, U4 and Q2 report this condition to the CPU on the Accutorr Plus.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 7 - Calibration
7-17
7.7 BATTERY TEST FOR ACCUTORR PLUS
NOTE: During this test, the real time clock will reset.
1. Disconnect the cable from the battery and remove the AC power cord from the UUT.
Connect the power supply positive output to the battery cable positive terminal and
the negative power supply terminal to the negative terminal of the battery cable. Set
the power supply voltage to 14.5, ± .1 volts for SLA battery, 12.5 ± .1 volts for Li-Ion
battery.
2. Press the On/Standby key to power up UUT. Verify that the normal power up
sequence as described in this document occurs and that the indicator for the battery
symbol on the keypad is lit.
7.7.1
Low Battery Indicator and Low Battery Cut-Off
CAUTION: During this test, the real time clock will be reset and any Trend information will be
lost. Temporary user preference settings will also be erased.
Power Supply requirement: the power source used for testing needs to source 0 to 15
VDC and able to withstand current spikes of 3 to 4 Amperes without current or voltage
sags.
1. Remove the battery pack and AC mains cord. Remove monitor rear cover. Disconnect
the Battery Connector cable from the power supply.
2. Set the external power supply voltage to 14.5 VDC, current limit set to 4 Amps. Connect the positive of the external power supply to the input side of the F3 fuse. (4 A)
Connect the negative side of the external power supply to the negative pin of the
Accutorr Plus power supply or to the chassis near the battery connector.
3. Connect a DVM to the load side of F3 of the Accutorr Plus power supply and the
chassis of the Accutorr Plus. This method will read the actual voltage applied to the
internal power supply and will be the reading used to determine the Low Battery Indicator and Low Battery Cut-Off voltages.
4. Turn the monitor ON, and allow to complete the self check initialization.
5. Slowly decrease the external power supply voltage, in approximately 100 mv. steps,
every 0 seconds. Note the voltage where the Battery LED begins to flash. Note this
voltage and compare to the specification in the following table. Continue to decrease
the voltage until the monitor turns off. This is the Low Battery cut-off voltage. Note
this voltage and compare to the specification in the following table.
Type of Battery Installed
Sealed Lead Acid
Lithium Ion
Low Battery Indicator limits Low Battery Cut-Off limits
10.95 to 11.63 VDC
9.8 to 10.7 VDC
9.95 to 10.61 VDC
8.7 to 9.5 VDC
6. Turn the monitor Off, re assemble and install the battery pack.
7-18
Revised 03/25/02
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 7 - Calibration
7.7.2
Set the Current Time
1. Press and hold the Timer/Temp key for 3
seconds. The hour digit only displays.
2. Press the Up or Down Arrow key to change
Hour
Display
TIMER/TEMP
INTERVAL ELAP
. TIME TEMP
ALARMS
SET
ALARMS
MUTE
the number.
Press and hold
to enter the clock
set mode. Set hour,
then press again to
set the minute.
Press to Change
3. Press the Timer/Temp key to activate the
minute display.
NOTE: The Accutorr Plus always displays
time in a 24 hour format.
Figure 7-3 - Hour Display
Minute
Display
TIMER/TEMP
INTERVAL ELAP
. TIME TEMP
ALARMS
4. Press the Up or Down Arrow key (12 or 13)
to change the number. Continue pressing
the Timer/Temp key and the Arrow keys to
set the month, day, and year (in that order).
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 7 - Calibration
MUTE
SET
ALARMS
After the time
and date have
been set, press
to exit the clock
set mode.
Press to Change
Figure 7-4 - Minute Display
Revised 03/25/02
7-19
7.8 NIBP NORMAL OPERATION
1. Press the left arrow key on the “Cufflink” Simulator to highlight SELECT BP,
then press the ENT key. Set pressure test to 120/80 (90) and press the ENT key.
2. Attach the simulator “Cufflink” to the input pressure fitting of UUT.
3. Press the interval key of the keypad until a 1 is shown in the Timer/Temp./Interval
LED of the UUT. Press the Patient Size key to select Adult size indicator.
4. Press the Set Alarms key to enter the alarm setting mode. Use the Up and Down
arrow keys to set the Systolic Low alarm to 115 mmHg.
5. Press the Set Alarms key again and set the Diastolic Low Alarm to 95 mmHg.
6. Press the Start NIBP key. Verify the monitor takes a measurement and the Systolic
and the Diastolic low alarms are violated. The LED’s for these parameters will blink
on and off and an alarm tone will sound for the violation. Press the Mute Key to
silence the alarms.
7. After the fifth measurement is complete, allow the cuff to pump up. Press Deflate
key. Verify cuff deflates.
8. Review the data that was stored in the database, by scrolling through the patient trend
information. Use the Up and Down Room and Bed keys or LCD display of the UUT
and verify that the Systolic and Diastolic information is available in the LED’s for each
stored settings
9. Remove the cuff from the UUT and press the Start key. Confirm that the UUT pump
runs and that it displays a “-10" in the Systolic LED within 60 seconds and attempts
another inflation. Press the Deflate key to stop test.
7-20
Revised 03/25/02
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 7 - Calibration
7.9 TREND MEMORY INITIALIZATION
1. To clear the UUT Trend Memory for all patient settings, press and hold the
Delete Info. key while powering up the unit.
7.10
SpO2 NORMAL OPERATION
(Accutorr Plus model with SpO2)
NOTE: This procedure can be accomplished with the Biotek “Index” SpO2 simulator
or an equivalent SpO2 simulator.
The purpose of this test is to verify that an SpO2 signal is recognized, alarm limits
are captured and the data is trended. A full operational test may be conducted, if so
warranted, within the limits of the published specification. See chapter 3 of this
manual for specifications.
1. Set the simulator to an SpO2 saturation level of 98%, pulse rate of 60 bpm, and a
pulse amplitude of 100%.
2. Set the Accutorr Plus SpO2 HI alarm limit to 95% and the pulse rate HI alarm
limit to 55 bpm.
3. Connect an NIBP cuff or a suitable simulator to the Accutorr Plus and start a
measurement.
4. Confirm that the Accutorr Plus has determined an SpO2 saturation level and has
violated the SpO2 HI alarm and the pulse rate HI alarm (flashing digits and alarm
tone). Press the MUTE key to silence the alarms.
5. Check the trend screen to confirm that the measurement information has been saved.
6. Set the SpO2 HI alarm to OFF and SpO2 LOW alarm to 86.
7. Set the simulator to an SpO2 saturation level of 90%, pulse rate of 95 bpm, and the
pulse amplitude to approximately 10% (Weak Pulse Datascope SpO2 only, low
perfusion Masimo SpO2 only).
8. The Accutorr Plus may intermittently determine SpO2 values or indicate a status code
of 8853 (Pulse Search) or 8854 (Weak Pulse / Low Perfusion will display). Adjust the
simulators pulse amplitude up and down until either status code of 8853 or 8854
displays.
9. Restore normal simulation parameters as described in step 1.
10. Remove the sensor from the simulator to induce a status code of 8851 (Sensor Off
Datascope SpO2 or Masimo SpO2 only).
11. Disconnect the sensor from the Accutorr Plus to produce a status code of 8850 (No
Sensor).
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 7 - Calibration
Revised 03/25/02
7-21
NIBP
SYS.
START
NIBP
PATIENT
SETUP
DEFLATE
DIA.
INTERVAL
TIMER/TEMP
MAP
INTERVAL ELAP. TIME TEMP
ALARMS
NIBP
SET
ALARMS
MUTE
Sp02
ROOM
BED
PATIENT INFO.
SpO2
DATA
SCAN
ROOM
BED
DELETE
INFO.
MEMORY FULL
20/05
20/05
20/05
20/05
20/05
03:00
02:58
02:35
02:33
02:30
S / D / M
114/64 83
123/61 84
127/62 83
185/105 135
129/62 84
61
60
58
56
59
+ -
MENU
SELECT
DEFAULTS
PRINT
HOLD TO CLEAR.
F/C %SPO2
98.7
96
98.5
97
96
97.6
96
---98.2
97
o
ON
STANDBY
Figure 7-5 Accutorr Plus NIBP with Trend Screen and Datascope SpO2
NIBP
SYS.
START
NIBP
PATIENT
SETUP
DEFLATE
DIA.
INTERVAL
TIMER/TEMP
MAP
INTERVAL ELAP
. TIME TEMP
ALARMS
NIBP
SET
ALARMS
MUTE
Sp0 2
ROOM
BED
PATIENT INFO.
SpO
2
DATA
SCAN
ROOM
BED
DELETE
INFO.
MEMORY FULL
20/05
20/05
20/05
20/05
20/05
03:00
02:58
02:35
02:33
02:30
S/D/M
114/64 83
123/61 84
127/62 83
185/105 135
129/62 84
61
60
58
56
59
F/C %SPO2
98.7
96
98.5
97
96
97.6
96
---97
98.2
+ -
MENU
SELECT
PRINT
HOLD TO CLEAR.
o
DEFAULTS
ON
STANDBY
Figure 7-6 Accutorr Plus NIBP with Trend Screen and Nellcor® or Masimo®
SpO2
7-22
Revised 03/25/02
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 7 - Calibration
NIBP
SYS.
START
NIBP
PATIENT
SETUP
DEFLATE
DIA.
INTERVAL
TIMER/TEMP
MAP
INTERVAL ELAP. TIME TEMP
ALARMS
NIBP
SET
ALARMS
MUTE
ROOM
BED
PATIENT INFO.
DATA
SCAN
ROOM
BED
DELETE
INFO.
MEMORY FULL
20/05
20/05
20/05
20/05
20/05
03:00
02:58
02:35
02:33
02:30
S / D /
114/64
123/61
127/62
185/105
129/62
M
83
84
83
135
84
HOLD TO CLEAR.
F/C %SPO2
98.7
96
98.5
97
96
97.6
96
---98.2
97
o
61
60
58
56
59
+ -
MENU
SELECT
PRINT
ON
STANDBY
DEFAULTS
Figure 7-7 Accutorr Plus NIBP with Trend Screen
NIBP
SYS.
START
NIBP
PATIENT
SETUP
DEFLATE
DIA.
INTERVAL
TIMER/TEMP
MAP
INTERVAL ELAP. TIME TEMP
NIBP
ALARMS
SET
ALARMS
MUTE
ROOM
BED
PATIENT INFO.
DATA
SCAN
ROOM
BED
DELETE
INFO.
MEMORY FULL
+ -
PRINT
DEFAULTS
HOLD TO CLEAR.
ON
STANDBY
Figure 7-8 Accutorr Plus NIBP
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 7 - Calibration
Revised 03/25/02
7-23
This page intentionally left blank.
7-24
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 7 - Calibration
8.0 PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE
CONTENTS OF THIS CHAPTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Page
8.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1
8.2 Limitations of Physiological Simulators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1
8.3 Preventive Maintenance Schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2
8.3.1 Mechanical and Physical Visual Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2
8.3.2 Electrical Safety and Performance Checks (Six Month Interval) . . . 8-2
8.3.3 Electrical Safety and Performance Checks (One Year Interval). . . . 8-2
8.1 INTRODUCTION
The intent of this procedure is to ensure that the product continues to be safe and
effective in it’s intended environment. Complete knowledge of the instrument
characteristics and it’s relationship to the clinical environment are useful in
determining changes in the performance of the monitor, and the clinical
limitations of the device.
As a general rule, the instrument is not tested to the full limits of it’s capabilities at each
service interval. Rather, representative points are tested and the results recorded. It is
important to note that while not all functions are tested to the absolute limits, every
function and option should be exercised. Declining performance over time is frequently
the first indication of the need for more extensive service action.
8.2 LIMITATIONS OF PHYSIOLOGICAL SIMULATORS
The physiological simulator is the principle aid for problem solving. Simulators have
many of the same limitations as the devices that they will test. It is imperative that the
simulator correlate well to a “Reference Standard*”. The electronic simulators available
attempt to replicate a broad spectrum of indices representative of normal and abnormal
physiological events, within the interpretation of the manufacturer.
Most simulators (properly maintained) will provide reasonably accurate and consistent
results, but may not produce the exact results when connected to similar monitors from
different manufacturers. However, the consistent performance of a simulator is a good
indicator of any change in the performance in the monitor.
* For example, an accurate mercury column for pressure verification.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 8 - Preventive Maintenance
8-1
8.3 PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE
The following preventive maintenance steps are required for continued satisfactory
performance and safety of the Accutorr Plus and optional accessories. Inspections and
replacement of consumable supplies and accessories that are subject to normal wear, must
be accomplished at least as frequently as the inspection of the host unit. Read the
Warranty statement in the Operating Instructions for description of warranty conditions.
The suggested minimum maintenance schedule is based on normally expected wear and
tear of system and components. The intervals may be shortened at the user’s discretion
when conditions of use may warrant. In case of internal instrument failure, component
replacement, and possible or actual instrument damage, it is strongly recommended that
complete performance and safety verification be conducted.
8.3.1 Mechanical and Physical Visual Inspection (One Year Interval)
Check the following items for wear and physical damage: Repair or replace as needed.
• Outer case of Accutorr Plus, Recorder and Temperature module.
• Patient connected accessories such as blood pressure cuffs and hoses and related
connectors. Check the SpO2 sensor and cables. Check the temperature cables and
probes. Verify and replenish the disposable items as needed. (IE: probe covers,
recorder chart supply).
• Power cords, external safety ground connections and communication cables.
8.3.2 Electrical Safety and Performance Checks (One Year Interval)
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
8-2
Revised 2/15/00
Line power and battery power indicator lights functional in the proper modes.
Line power and safety grounds are intact and within specifications.
Non-invasive blood pressure section is functional within specifications.
SpO2 functions are operational and within specification.
Temperature functions are operational and within specifications. Check the
temperature module battery voltage under load: replace if under 8.8 V. Use only
alkaline batteries. NOTE: Newer PTM modules do not contain a 9V battery.
Recorder is functional and documents available stored data.
Error codes, failure messages, end user reported anomalies are collected and
analyzed for reduced performance trends. Identify and correct causes as warranted.
Check recorder paper path and clean as required.
Perform ground resistance and chassis leakage tests.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 8 - Preventive Maintenance
This page intentionally left blank.
Accutorr Plus Service Manual
Chapter 8 - Preventive Maintenance
8-3
Printed in U.S.A.
0070-10-0429
Rev AC
September 20, 2007

advertisement

Was this manual useful for you? Yes No
Thank you for your participation!

* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project

Related manuals

Download PDF

advertisement